blob: 1d7bc7adb6401a68008f85b9649994ed73327887 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau15480d72014-06-19 21:10:58 +02005 version 1.6
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau9229f122014-06-19 21:01:06 +02007 2014/06/19
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200727.3.1. Converters
737.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
757.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
767.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
777.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200787.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079
808. Logging
818.1. Log levels
828.2. Log formats
838.2.1. Default log format
848.2.2. TCP log format
858.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100868.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100878.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200888.3. Advanced logging options
898.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
908.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
918.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
928.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
938.4. Timing events
948.5. Session state at disconnection
958.6. Non-printable characters
968.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
978.8. Capturing HTTP headers
988.9. Examples of logs
99
1009. Statistics and monitoring
1019.1. CSV format
1029.2. Unix Socket commands
103
104
1051. Quick reminder about HTTP
106----------------------------
107
108When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
109fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
110on almost anything found in the contents.
111
112However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
113formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
114correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
115
116
1171.1. The HTTP transaction model
118-------------------------------
119
120The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100121to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
123connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
124will involve a new connection :
125
126 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
127
128In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
129establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
130by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
131length.
132
133Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
134to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
135however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
136response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
137header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
138
139 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
140
141Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
142power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
143but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200144a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145
146A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
147keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
148second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
149page :
150
151 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
152
153This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
154latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
155correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
156the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100157server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100159By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
160connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
161leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
162start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100164HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
165 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
166 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
167 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
168 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
169 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
170 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
1731.2. HTTP request
174-----------------
175
176First, let's consider this HTTP request :
177
178 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100179 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
181 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
182 3 User-agent: my small browser
183 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
184 5 Accept: image/png
185
186
1871.2.1. The Request line
188-----------------------
189
190Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
191
192 - a METHOD : GET
193 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
194 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
195
196All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
197which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
198followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
199is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
200desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
201the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
202
203The URI itself can have several forms :
204
205 - A "relative URI" :
206
207 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
208
209 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
210 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
211
212 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
213
214 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
217 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
218 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
219 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
220 must accept this form too.
221
222 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
223 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
224 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
227 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
228 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
229 other protocols too.
230
231In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
232mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
233on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
234It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
235specific to the language, framework or application in use.
236
237
2381.2.2. The request headers
239--------------------------
240
241The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
242beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
243an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
244Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
245values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
246encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
247the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
248define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
249
250Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
251their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
252"Connection:" header).
253
254The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
255that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
256is one valid form of empty line.
257
258Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
259headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
260about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
261application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
262
263Important note:
264 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
265 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
266 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
267 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
268
269
2701.3. HTTP response
271------------------
272
273An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
274messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
275
276 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100277 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200278 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
279 2 Content-length: 350
280 3 Content-Type: text/html
281
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200282As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
283codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
284response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100285continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
286the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
287following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
288sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
289(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
290correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
291such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
292state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
293over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
294if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
295information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297
2981.3.1. The Response line
299------------------------
300
301Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
302
303 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
304 - a status code : 200
305 - a reason : OK
306
307The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200308 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
310 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
311 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
312 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
313
314Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100315"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
317messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
318or "Authentication Required".
319
320Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
321
322 Code When / reason
323 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
324 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
326 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100327 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
328 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200329 400 for an invalid or too large request
330 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
331 accessing the stats page)
332 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
333 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
334 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
335 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
336 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
337 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
338 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
339 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
340 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
341
342The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3434.2).
344
345
3461.3.2. The response headers
347---------------------------
348
349Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
350the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
351details.
352
353
3542. Configuring HAProxy
355----------------------
356
3572.1. Configuration file format
358------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200359
360HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
361
362 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
363 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
364 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
365 "frontend" and "backend".
366
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100367The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
368referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
369delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100370preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100371escaped by doubling them.
372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373
3742.2. Time format
375----------------
376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100377Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100378values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
379otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
380numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
381for every keyword. Supported units are :
382
383 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
384 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
385 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
386 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
387 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
388 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
389
390
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003912.3. Examples
392-------------
393
394 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
395 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
396 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
397 global
398 daemon
399 maxconn 256
400
401 defaults
402 mode http
403 timeout connect 5000ms
404 timeout client 50000ms
405 timeout server 50000ms
406
407 frontend http-in
408 bind *:80
409 default_backend servers
410
411 backend servers
412 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
413
414
415 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
416 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
417 global
418 daemon
419 maxconn 256
420
421 defaults
422 mode http
423 timeout connect 5000ms
424 timeout client 50000ms
425 timeout server 50000ms
426
427 listen http-in
428 bind *:80
429 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
430
431
432Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
433
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100434 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200435
436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004373. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438--------------------
439
440Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
441are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
442of them have command-line equivalents.
443
444The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
445
446 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200447 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200448 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200449 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200450 - daemon
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900451 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200452 - gid
453 - group
454 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100455 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200456 - nbproc
457 - pidfile
458 - uid
459 - ulimit-n
460 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200461 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100462 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200463 - node
464 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100465 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100466
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200467 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200468 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200469 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200470 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100471 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100472 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100473 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200474 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200475 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200476 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200477 - noepoll
478 - nokqueue
479 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100480 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300481 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200482 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200483 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200484 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100485 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100486 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200487 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100488 - tune.idletimer
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100489 - tune.maxaccept
490 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200491 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200492 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100493 - tune.rcvbuf.client
494 - tune.rcvbuf.server
495 - tune.sndbuf.client
496 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100497 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100498 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200499 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100500 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200501 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100502 - tune.zlib.memlevel
503 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100504
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200505 * Debugging
506 - debug
507 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200508
509
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005103.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200511------------------------------------
512
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200513ca-base <dir>
514 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200515 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
516 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200517
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200518chroot <jail dir>
519 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
520 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
521 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
522 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
523 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
524 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100525
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100526cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
527 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
528 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
529 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100530 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
531 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
532 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
533 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
534 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
535 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
536 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
537 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
538 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
539 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100540
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200541crt-base <dir>
542 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
543 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
544 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
545
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200546daemon
547 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
548 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
549 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
550
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900551external-check
552 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
553 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
554 See "option external-check".
555
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200556gid <number>
557 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
558 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
559 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100560 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
561 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200562 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100563
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200564group <group name>
565 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
566 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100567
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200568log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200569 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
570 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100571 configured with "log global".
572
573 <address> can be one of:
574
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100575 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100576 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
577 port).
578
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100579 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
580 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
581 port).
582
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100583 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
584 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
585 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
586 writeable).
587
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100588 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
589 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
590 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
591 in Bourne shell.
592
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200593 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
594 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
595 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
596 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
597 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
598 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
599 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
600 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
601 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
602 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
603 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
604
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100605 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200606
607 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
608 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
609 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
610
611 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200612 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
613 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
614 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
615 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
616 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
617 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200618
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200619 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200620
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100621log-send-hostname [<string>]
622 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
623 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
624 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
625 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
626 the logs.
627
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000628log-tag <string>
629 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
630 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
631 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
632 running on the same host.
633
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200634nbproc <number>
635 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
636 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
637 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
638 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
639 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
640
641pidfile <pidfile>
642 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
643 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
644 starting the process. See also "daemon".
645
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100646stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200647 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
648 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
649 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
650 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
651 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
652 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100653 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200654 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
655 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200656
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100657ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
658 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
659 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300660 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100661 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
662 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
663 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
664 "bind" keyword for more information.
665
666ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
667 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
668 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300669 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100670 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
671 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
672 information.
673
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100674ssl-server-verify [none|required]
675 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
676 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
677 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
678
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200679stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
680 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
681 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
682 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
683 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200684
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200685 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
686 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
687 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200688
689stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
690 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
691 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100692 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200693
694stats maxconn <connections>
695 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
696 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
697
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200698uid <number>
699 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
700 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
701 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
702 one. See also "gid" and "user".
703
704ulimit-n <number>
705 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
706 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
707 option.
708
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100709unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
710 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
711
712 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
713 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
714 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
715 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
716 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
717 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
718 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
719 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
720 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
721 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
722
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200723user <user name>
724 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
725 See also "uid" and "group".
726
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200727node <name>
728 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
729
730 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
731 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
732 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
733 traffic.
734
735description <text>
736 Add a text that describes the instance.
737
738 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
739 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
740 "<" and ">" characters.
741
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200742
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007433.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200744-----------------------
745
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200746max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
747 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
748 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
749 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
750 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
751 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
752 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
753 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
754 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
755
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200756maxconn <number>
757 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
758 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
759 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +0200760 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
761 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
762 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
763 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
764 below 500 in general).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200765
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200766maxconnrate <number>
767 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
768 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
769 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
770 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
771 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
772 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
773 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
774 fairness.
775
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100776maxcomprate <number>
777 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300778 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100779 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
780 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
781 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
782 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
783 default value.
784
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100785maxcompcpuusage <number>
786 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
787 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
788 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
789 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
790 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
791 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
792 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
793 process down and from introducing high latencies.
794
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100795maxpipes <number>
796 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
797 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
798 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
799 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
800 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
801 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
802
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200803maxsessrate <number>
804 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
805 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
806 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
807 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
808 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
809 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
810 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
811 fairness.
812
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200813maxsslconn <number>
814 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
815 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
816 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
817 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
818 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
819 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
820 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
821
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200822maxsslrate <number>
823 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
824 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
825 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
826 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
827 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
828 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
829 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
830 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
831 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
832 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
833
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100834maxzlibmem <number>
835 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
836 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
837 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100838 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
839 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
840 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
841
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200842noepoll
843 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
844 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100845 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200846
847nokqueue
848 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
849 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
850 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
851
852nopoll
853 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
854 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100855 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100856 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200857
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100858nosplice
859 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
860 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
861 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100862 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100863 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
864 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
865 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
866 "option splice-response".
867
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300868nogetaddrinfo
869 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
870 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
871
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200872spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900873 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
874 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
875 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
876 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
877 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
878 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200879
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200880tune.bufsize <number>
881 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
882 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
883 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
884 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
885 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
886 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
887 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
888 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400889 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
890 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
891 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200892
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200893tune.chksize <number>
894 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
895 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
896 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
897 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
898 checks whenever possible.
899
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100900tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
901 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
902 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
903 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
904 this value. The default value is 1.
905
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100906tune.http.cookielen <number>
907 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
908 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
909 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
910 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
911 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
912 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
913 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
914 to change this value.
915
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200916tune.http.maxhdr <number>
917 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
918 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
919 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
920 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
921 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
922 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
923 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
924 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
925 limit too high.
926
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100927tune.idletimer <timeout>
928 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
929 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
930 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
931 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
932 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
933 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
934 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
935 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
936 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
937
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100938tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100939 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
940 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
941 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
942 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
943 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
944 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
945 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
946 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
947 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
948 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100949
950tune.maxpollevents <number>
951 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
952 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
953 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
954 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
955 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
956
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200957tune.maxrewrite <number>
958 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
959 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
960 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
961 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
962 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
963 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
964 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
965 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
966 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
967 bufsize.
968
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200969tune.pipesize <number>
970 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
971 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
972 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
973 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
974 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
975 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
976
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100977tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
978tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
979 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
980 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
981 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
982 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
983 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
984 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
985 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
986
987tune.sndbuf.client <number>
988tune.sndbuf.server <number>
989 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
990 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
991 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
992 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
993 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
994 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
995 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
996 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
997 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
998 notifying haproxy again.
999
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001000tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001001 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1002 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1003 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001004 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001005 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1006 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1007 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1008 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1009 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001010 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1011 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001012
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001013tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1014 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1015 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1016 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1017 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1018 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1019 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1020
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001021tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1022 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001023 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001024 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1025 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1026 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1027 being used for too long.
1028
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001029tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1030 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1031 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1032 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1033 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1034 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1035 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1036 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1037 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1038 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1039 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001040 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1041 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001042
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001043tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1044 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1045 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1046 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1047 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1048 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1049 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1050 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
1051 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied via the certificate file.
1052
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001053tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1054 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001055 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001056 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1057 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1058 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1059
1060tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1061 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1062 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1063 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1064 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001065
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010663.3. Debugging
1067--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001068
1069debug
1070 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1071 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1072 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1073 system startup.
1074
1075quiet
1076 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1077 line argument "-q".
1078
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001079
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010803.4. Userlists
1081--------------
1082It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1083http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1084it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1085
1086userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001087 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001088 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1089
1090group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001091 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001092 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1093 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1094
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001095user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1096 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001097 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1098 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001099 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1100 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001101 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001102 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001103
1104
1105 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001106 userlist L1
1107 group G1 users tiger,scott
1108 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001109
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001110 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1111 user scott insecure-password elgato
1112 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001113
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001114 userlist L2
1115 group G1
1116 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001117
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001118 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1119 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1120 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001121
1122 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001123
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001124
11253.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001126----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001127It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1128haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1129pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1130identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1131or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1132Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1133known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1134the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1135process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1136during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1137tables.
1138
1139peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001140 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001141 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1142
1143peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1144 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1145 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1146 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1147 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1148 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1149 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1150
1151 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1152 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1153
1154 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1155 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1156 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1157 across all peers.
1158
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001159 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1160 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1161 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1162
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001163 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001164 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001165 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1166 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1167 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001168
1169 backend mybackend
1170 mode tcp
1171 balance roundrobin
1172 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1173 stick on src
1174
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001175 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1176 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001177
1178
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011794. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001180----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001181
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001182Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1183 - defaults <name>
1184 - frontend <name>
1185 - backend <name>
1186 - listen <name>
1187
1188A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1189its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1190section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001191section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001192
1193A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1194connections.
1195
1196A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1197to forward incoming connections.
1198
1199A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1200parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1201
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001202All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1203'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1204case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1205
1206Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1207logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1208proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1209However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1210name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1211
1212Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1213and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001214bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001215protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1216modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1217arbitrary criteria.
1218
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001219In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1220a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1221the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1222
1223 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1224 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1225 between responses and new requests.
1226
1227 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1228 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1229 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1230 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1231
1232 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1233 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1234 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1235
1236 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1237 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1238 client-facing connection remains open.
1239
1240 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1241 after the end of the response.
1242
1243The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1244frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1245following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1246weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1247
1248 Backend mode
1249
1250 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1251 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1252 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1253 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1254 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1255 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1256 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1257 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1258 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1259 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1260 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1261
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001262
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001263
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012644.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1265--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001266
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001267The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1268limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1269they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1270limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001271marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001272option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001273and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1274with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1275specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001276
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001277
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001278 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1279------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1280acl - X X X
1281appsession - - X X
1282backlog X X X -
1283balance X - X X
1284bind - X X -
1285bind-process X X X X
1286block - X X X
1287capture cookie - X X -
1288capture request header - X X -
1289capture response header - X X -
1290clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001291compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001292contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1293cookie X - X X
1294default-server X - X X
1295default_backend X X X -
1296description - X X X
1297disabled X X X X
1298dispatch - - X X
1299enabled X X X X
1300errorfile X X X X
1301errorloc X X X X
1302errorloc302 X X X X
1303-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1304errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001305force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001306fullconn X - X X
1307grace X X X X
1308hash-type X - X X
1309http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001310http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001311http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001312http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001313http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001314http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001315id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001316ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001317log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001318max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001319maxconn X X X -
1320mode X X X X
1321monitor fail - X X -
1322monitor-net X X X -
1323monitor-uri X X X -
1324option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1325option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1326option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1327option allbackups (*) X - X X
1328option checkcache (*) X - X X
1329option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1330option contstats (*) X X X -
1331option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1332option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1333option forceclose (*) X X X X
1334-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1335option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001336option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001337option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001338option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001339option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001340option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001341option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1342option httpchk X - X X
1343option httpclose (*) X X X X
1344option httplog X X X X
1345option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001346option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001347option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001348option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001349option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1350option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1351option logasap (*) X X X -
1352option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001353option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001354option nolinger (*) X X X X
1355option originalto X X X X
1356option persist (*) X - X X
1357option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001358option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001359option smtpchk X - X X
1360option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1361option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1362option splice-request (*) X X X X
1363option splice-response (*) X X X X
1364option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1365option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1366-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001367option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001368option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1369option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1370option tcpka X X X X
1371option tcplog X X X X
1372option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001373external-check command X - X X
1374external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001375persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1376rate-limit sessions X X X -
1377redirect - X X X
1378redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1379redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1380reqadd - X X X
1381reqallow - X X X
1382reqdel - X X X
1383reqdeny - X X X
1384reqiallow - X X X
1385reqidel - X X X
1386reqideny - X X X
1387reqipass - X X X
1388reqirep - X X X
1389reqisetbe - X X X
1390reqitarpit - X X X
1391reqpass - X X X
1392reqrep - X X X
1393-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1394reqsetbe - X X X
1395reqtarpit - X X X
1396retries X - X X
1397rspadd - X X X
1398rspdel - X X X
1399rspdeny - X X X
1400rspidel - X X X
1401rspideny - X X X
1402rspirep - X X X
1403rsprep - X X X
1404server - - X X
1405source X - X X
1406srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001407stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001408stats auth X - X X
1409stats enable X - X X
1410stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001411stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001412stats realm X - X X
1413stats refresh X - X X
1414stats scope X - X X
1415stats show-desc X - X X
1416stats show-legends X - X X
1417stats show-node X - X X
1418stats uri X - X X
1419-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1420stick match - - X X
1421stick on - - X X
1422stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001423stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001424stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001425tcp-check connect - - X X
1426tcp-check expect - - X X
1427tcp-check send - - X X
1428tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001429tcp-request connection - X X -
1430tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001431tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001432tcp-response content - - X X
1433tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001434timeout check X - X X
1435timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001436timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001437timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1438timeout connect X - X X
1439timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1440timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1441timeout http-request X X X X
1442timeout queue X - X X
1443timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001444timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001445timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1446timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001447timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001448transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001449unique-id-format X X X -
1450unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001451use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001452use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001453------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1454 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001455
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001456
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1458---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001459
1460This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1461
1462
1463acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1464 Declare or complete an access list.
1465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1466 no | yes | yes | yes
1467 Example:
1468 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1469 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1470 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1471
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001472 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001473
1474
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001475appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1476 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001477 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1478 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1479 no | no | yes | yes
1480 Arguments :
1481 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1482 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1483
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001484 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001485 checked in each cookie value.
1486
1487 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1488 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1489 milliseconds.
1490
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001491 request-learn
1492 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1493 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1494 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1495 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1496 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1497 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1498
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001499 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1500 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1501 data following this prefix.
1502
1503 Example :
1504 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1505
1506 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1507 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1508
1509 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1510 2 modes are currently supported :
1511 - path-parameters :
1512 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1513 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1514 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1515 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1516 - query-string :
1517 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1518 query string.
1519
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001520 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1521 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1522 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1523 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001524 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1525 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1526 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001527 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1528 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1529
1530 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1531
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001532 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1533 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1534 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1535
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001536 Example :
1537 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1538
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001539 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1540 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001541
1542
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001543backlog <conns>
1544 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1546 yes | yes | yes | no
1547 Arguments :
1548 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1549 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001550 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001551
1552 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1553 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1554 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1555 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1556 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1557 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1558 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1559 backlog parameter.
1560
1561 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1562 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1563 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1564
1565 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1566
1567
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001568balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001569balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001570 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1571 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1572 yes | no | yes | yes
1573 Arguments :
1574 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1575 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1576 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1577 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1578
1579 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1580 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1581 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1582 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001583 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001584 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001585 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1586 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1587 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1588 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1589 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1590 it, so that you don't worry.
1591
1592 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1593 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1594 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1595 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1596 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1597 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1598 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1599 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001600
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001601 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1602 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1603 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1604 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1605 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1606 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1607 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1608 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1609
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001610 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001611 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001612 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1613 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001614 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001615 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1616 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1617 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1618 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1619 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001620 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1621 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1622 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1623 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1624 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1625 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001626
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001627 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1628 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1629 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1630 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1631 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1632 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1633 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1634 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001635 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001636 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001637 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1638 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1639 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001640
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001641 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1642 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1643 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1644 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1645 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1646 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1647 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1648 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1649 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1650 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1651 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1652 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001653
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001654 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001655 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1656 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1657 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1658 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1659 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1660 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1661 URIs start with a leading "/".
1662
1663 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1664 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1665 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1666 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1667
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001668 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001669 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1670
1671 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001672 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1673 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001674 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1675 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1676 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1677 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001678 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001679 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1680 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001681
1682 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1683 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1684 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1685 server will receive the request.
1686
1687 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1688 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1689 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1690 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1691 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001692 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1693 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1694 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001695
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001696 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1697 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1698 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1699 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1700 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001701
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001702 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001703 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1704 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1705 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1706
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001707 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1708 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1709 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1710
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001711 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001712 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001713 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1714 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1715 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1716 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1717 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1718 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001719 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001720 used instead.
1721
1722 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1723 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1724 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1725 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1726
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001727 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1728 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1729 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1730
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001731 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001732
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001733 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001734 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1735 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001736
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001737 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1738 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1739 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001740
1741 Examples :
1742 balance roundrobin
1743 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001744 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001745 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1746 balance hdr(host)
1747 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001748
1749 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1750 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1751
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001752 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001753 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1754 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1755 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1756 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1757
1758 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1759 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1760 defaults to 16 kB.
1761
1762 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1763 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1764
1765 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1766 Round Robin.
1767
1768 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1769 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1770 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1771 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1772
1773 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1774
1775 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001776 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001777 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1778 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1779 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001780
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001781 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1782 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001783
1784
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001785bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1786bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001787 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1788 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1789 no | yes | yes | no
1790 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001791 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1792 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1793 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1794 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001795 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001796 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1797 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1798 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1799 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1800 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1801 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1802 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02001803 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
1804 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
1805 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
1806 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
1807 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
1808 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
1809 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001810 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1811 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1812 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001813 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1814 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1815 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1816 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001817
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001818 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1819 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001820 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1821 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1822 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001823 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1824 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1825 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1826 the range.
1827
1828 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1829 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1830 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1831 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1832 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1833 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1834 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001835 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001836 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001837
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001838 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1839 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1840 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1841 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1842 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1843 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1844 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1845 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1846
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001847 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1848 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1849 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1850 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001851
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001852 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1853 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1854 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1855 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1856 in a frontend.
1857
1858 Example :
1859 listen http_proxy
1860 bind :80,:443
1861 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001862 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001863
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001864 listen http_https_proxy
1865 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001866 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001867
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001868 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1869 bind ipv6@:80
1870 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1871 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1872
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001873 listen external_bind_app1
1874 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1875
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001876 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001877 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001878
1879
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001880bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001881 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1883 yes | yes | yes | yes
1884 Arguments :
1885 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1886 may be used to override a default value.
1887
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001888 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001889 option may be combined with other numbers.
1890
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001891 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001892 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1893 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1894 missing from all processes.
1895
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001896 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001897 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02001898 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
1899 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
1900 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
1901 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001902
1903 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1904 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1905 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1906 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1907 and 'even' instances.
1908
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001909 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
1910 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
1911 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
1912 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001913
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001914 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
1915 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
1916
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001917 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1918 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1919
1920 Example :
1921 listen app_ip1
1922 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001923 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001924
1925 listen app_ip2
1926 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001927 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001928
1929 listen management
1930 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001931 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001932
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001933 listen management
1934 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1935 bind-process 1-4
1936
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001937 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001938
1939
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001940block { if | unless } <condition>
1941 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1942 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1943 no | yes | yes | yes
1944
1945 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1946 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001947 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001948 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001949 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1950 "block" statements per instance.
1951
1952 Example:
1953 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1954 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1955 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1956 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1957
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001958 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001959
1960
1961capture cookie <name> len <length>
1962 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1963 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1964 no | yes | yes | no
1965 Arguments :
1966 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1967 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1968 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1969 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1970 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1971
1972 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1973 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1974 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1975 right if it exceeds <length>.
1976
1977 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1978 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1979 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1980 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1981
1982 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1983 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1984 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1985
1986 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1987 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1988 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001989 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
1990 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
1991 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001992
1993 Example:
1994 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1995
1996 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001997 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001998
1999
2000capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002001 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002002 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2003 no | yes | yes | no
2004 Arguments :
2005 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002006 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002007 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2008 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2009 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2010
2011 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2012 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2013 it exceeds <length>.
2014
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002015 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002016 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2017 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002018 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2019 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2020 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2021 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002022 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002023 environments to find where the request came from.
2024
2025 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2026 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2027 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2028 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002029
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002030 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2031 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2032 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2033 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2034 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002035
2036 Example:
2037 capture request header Host len 15
2038 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
2039 capture request header Referrer len 15
2040
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002041 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002042 about logging.
2043
2044
2045capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002046 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002047 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2048 no | yes | yes | no
2049 Arguments :
2050 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002051 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002052 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2053 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2054 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2055
2056 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2057 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2058 it exceeds <length>.
2059
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002060 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002061 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2062 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2063 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002064 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2065 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2066 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2067 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002068
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002069 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2070 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2071 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2072 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2073 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002074
2075 Example:
2076 capture response header Content-length len 9
2077 capture response header Location len 15
2078
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002079 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002080 about logging.
2081
2082
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002083clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002084 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2086 yes | yes | yes | no
2087 Arguments :
2088 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2089 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2090 as explained at the top of this document.
2091
2092 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2093 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2094 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2095 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2096 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2097 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2098 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2099 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002100 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002101 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2102 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2103
2104 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2105 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2106 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2107 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2108 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2109 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2110
2111 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2112 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2113
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002114 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2115 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002116
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002117compression algo <algorithm> ...
2118compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002119compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002120 Enable HTTP compression.
2121 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2122 yes | yes | yes | yes
2123 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002124 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2125 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2126 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2127
2128 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002129 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002130 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2131 data.
2132
2133 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2134 support for zlib was built in.
2135
2136 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2137 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
2138 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
2139 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
2140 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
2141 in.
2142
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002143 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002144 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002145 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2146 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2147 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2148 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2149 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002150
2151 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2152 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2153 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2154 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2155 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002156 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2157 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2158 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2159 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2160 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
2161 then be used for such scenarios.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002162
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002163 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002164 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2165 "Accept-Encoding" header
2166 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002167 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002168 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2169 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002170 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2171 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2172 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2173 "multipart"
2174 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2175 header
2176 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2177 and later
2178 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2179 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002180
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002181 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2182 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002183
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002184 Examples :
2185 compression algo gzip
2186 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002187
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002188contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002189 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2191 yes | no | yes | yes
2192 Arguments :
2193 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2194 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2195 as explained at the top of this document.
2196
2197 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002198 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002199 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002200 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2201 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2202 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2203 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2204
2205 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2206 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2207 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2208 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2209 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2210 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2211
2212 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2213 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2214 instead.
2215
2216 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2217 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2218
2219
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002220cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002221 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2222 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002223 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2224 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2225 yes | no | yes | yes
2226 Arguments :
2227 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2228 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2229 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2230 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2231 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2232 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2233 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2234 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2235 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2236
2237 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2238 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2239 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2240 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2241 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2242 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2243 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2244 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2245 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2246 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2247 "insert" and "prefix".
2248
2249 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002250 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002251
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002252 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002253 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2254 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2255 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2256 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2257 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2258 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2259 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2260 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2261 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2262 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002263
2264 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2265 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2266 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2267 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2268 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2269 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2270 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2271 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2272 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2273 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002274 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2275 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2276 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002277
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002278 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2279 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2280 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002281 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2282 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2283 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2284 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002285 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2286 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2287 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002288
2289 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2290 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2291 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2292 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2293 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2294 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2295 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2296 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2297 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2298
2299 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2300 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2301 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2302 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2303 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2304 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2305 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2306 persistence cookie in the cache.
2307 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2308
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002309 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2310 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2311 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2312 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2313 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2314 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2315 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2316 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2317 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2318 they logout.
2319
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002320 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2321 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2322 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2323 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2324
2325 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2326 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2327 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2328 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2329 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2330 this attribute.
2331
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002332 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002333 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002334 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2335 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2336 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2337 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2338 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2339 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002340
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002341 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2342 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2343 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2344 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2345 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2346 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2347 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2348 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2349 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2350 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2351 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2352 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2353 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2354 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2355 the site.
2356
2357 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2358 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2359 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2360 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2361 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2362 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2363 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2364 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2365 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2366 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2367 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2368 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2369 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2370 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2371 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2372 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2373
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002374 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2375 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2376 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2377 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002378
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002379 Examples :
2380 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2381 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2382 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002383 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002384
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002385 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002386 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002387
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002388
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002389default-server [param*]
2390 Change default options for a server in a backend
2391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2392 yes | no | yes | yes
2393 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002394 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2395 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2396 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2397 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002398
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002399 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002400 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2401
2402 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002403
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002404
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002405default_backend <backend>
2406 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2407 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2408 yes | yes | yes | no
2409 Arguments :
2410 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2411
2412 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2413 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2414 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2415 will catch all undetermined requests.
2416
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002417 Example :
2418
2419 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2420 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2421 default_backend dynamic
2422
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002423 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2424
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002425
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002426description <string>
2427 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2429 no | yes | yes | yes
2430 Arguments : string
2431
2432 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2433 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2434 it describes.
2435 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2436
2437
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002438disabled
2439 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2440 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2441 yes | yes | yes | yes
2442 Arguments : none
2443
2444 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2445 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2446 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2447 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2448 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2449 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2450 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2451
2452 See also : "enabled"
2453
2454
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002455dispatch <address>:<port>
2456 Set a default server address
2457 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2458 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002459 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002460
2461 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2462 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2463 during start-up.
2464
2465 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2466 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2467 possible with normal servers.
2468
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002469 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002470 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2471 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2472 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2473 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2474
2475 See also : "server"
2476
2477
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002478enabled
2479 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2481 yes | yes | yes | yes
2482 Arguments : none
2483
2484 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2485 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2486
2487 See also : "disabled"
2488
2489
2490errorfile <code> <file>
2491 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2493 yes | yes | yes | yes
2494 Arguments :
2495 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002496 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002497
2498 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002499 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002500 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002501 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2502 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002503
2504 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2505 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2506 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2507
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002508 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2509
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002510 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2511 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2512 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2513 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2514
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002515 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2516 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2517 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2518 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2519 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2520 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2521
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002522 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2523 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2524 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002525 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002526 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2527
2528 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2529
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002530 Example :
2531 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02002532 errorfile 408 /dev/null # workaround Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002533 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2534 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2535
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002536
2537errorloc <code> <url>
2538errorloc302 <code> <url>
2539 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2541 yes | yes | yes | yes
2542 Arguments :
2543 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002544 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002545
2546 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2547 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2548 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2549 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2550 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2551
2552 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2553 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2554 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2555
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002556 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2557
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002558 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2559 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2560 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2561 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2562 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2563 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2564 request.
2565
2566 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2567
2568
2569errorloc303 <code> <url>
2570 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2571 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2572 yes | yes | yes | yes
2573 Arguments :
2574 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2575 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2576
2577 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2578 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2579 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2580 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2581 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2582
2583 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2584 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2585 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2586
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002587 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2588
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002589 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2590 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2591 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2592 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002593 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002594
2595 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2596
2597
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002598force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2599 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2600 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2601 no | yes | yes | yes
2602
2603 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2604 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2605 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2606 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2607 marked down for maintenance operations.
2608
2609 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2610 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2611 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2612 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2613 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2614 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2615 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2616 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2617 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2618
2619 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2620 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2621 is used.
2622
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002623 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002624 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002625
2626
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002627fullconn <conns>
2628 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2630 yes | no | yes | yes
2631 Arguments :
2632 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2633 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2634
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002635 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002636 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002637 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002638 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2639 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2640 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2641 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2642 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002643 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002644
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002645 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2646 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01002647 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
2648 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
2649 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002650
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002651 Example :
2652 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2653 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2654 # connections.
2655 backend dynamic
2656 fullconn 10000
2657 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2658 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2659
2660 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2661
2662
2663grace <time>
2664 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2665 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002666 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002667 Arguments :
2668 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2669 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2670 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2671
2672 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2673 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002674 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002675 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2676
2677 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2678 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2679 simplify it.
2680
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002681
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002682hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002683 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2684 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2685 yes | no | yes | yes
2686 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002687 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2688 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002689
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002690 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2691 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2692 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2693 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2694 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2695 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2696 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2697 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2698 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2699 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002700
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002701 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2702 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2703 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2704 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2705 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2706 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2707 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2708 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2709 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2710 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2711 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2712 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2713 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002714 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2715 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002716
2717 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2718
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002719 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002720 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2721 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2722 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002723 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2724 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2725 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002726
2727 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2728 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002729 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2730 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2731 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2732 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2733
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002734 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2735 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2736 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2737 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2738 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2739 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2740 parameter.
2741
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002742 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2743
2744 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2745 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2746 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2747 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2748 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2749 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2750 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2751 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2752 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2753 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2754 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2755 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002756
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002757 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2758 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2759 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002760
2761 See also : "balance", "server"
2762
2763
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002764http-check disable-on-404
2765 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002767 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002768 Arguments : none
2769
2770 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2771 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2772 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2773 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2774 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2775 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2776 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2777 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002778 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2779 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2780 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2781
2782 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2783
2784
2785http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002786 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002787 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002788 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002789 Arguments :
2790 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2791 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002792 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002793 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2794 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2795 details on the supported keywords.
2796
2797 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2798 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2799 with the usual backslash ('\').
2800
2801 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2802 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2803 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2804 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2805 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2806
2807 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002808 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002809 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2810 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2811 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2812
2813 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002814 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002815 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2816 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2817 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2818 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2819
2820 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002821 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002822 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2823 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2824 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2825 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2826 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2827 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2828 trace).
2829
2830 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002831 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002832 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2833 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2834 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2835 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2836 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2837 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2838
2839 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2840 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2841 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2842 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2843 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2844 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2845 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2846 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2847
2848 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2849 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2850
2851 Examples :
2852 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002853 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002854
2855 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002856 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002857
2858 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002859 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002860
2861 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002862 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002863
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002864 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002865
2866
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002867http-check send-state
2868 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2869 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2870 yes | no | yes | yes
2871 Arguments : none
2872
2873 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2874 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2875 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2876 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2877 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2878
2879 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2880 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2881 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2882 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2883 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2884 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2885 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2886 checked in multiple backends.
2887
2888 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2889 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2890
2891 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2892 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2893 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2894 one fails.
2895
2896 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2897 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2898 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2899
2900 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2901 server's queue.
2902
2903 Example of a header received by the application server :
2904 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2905 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2906
2907 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2908
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002909http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002910 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002911 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06002912 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
2913 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02002914 set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
2915 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2916 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2917 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2918 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
2919 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002920 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002921 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2922
2923 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2924 no | yes | yes | yes
2925
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002926 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2927 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2928 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2929 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2930 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002931
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002932 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2933 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2934 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2935
2936 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2937 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2938 are evaluated.
2939
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002940 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2941 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2942 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2943 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2944 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2945 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2946 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2947 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2948 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002949 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002950 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2951
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002952 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2953 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2954 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2955 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2956 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2957
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002958 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2959 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2960 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01002961 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
2962 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002963
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002964 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2965 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2966 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2967 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2968 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2969 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2970 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2971 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2972
2973 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2974 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2975 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2976 external users.
2977
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002978 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
2979 <name>.
2980
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06002981 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
2982 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
2983 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
2984 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
2985 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
2986 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
2987 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
2988 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
2989
2990 Example:
2991
2992 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
2993
2994 applied to:
2995
2996 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
2997
2998 outputs:
2999
3000 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3001
3002 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3003
3004 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3005 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3006 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3007 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3008 header.
3009
3010 Example:
3011
3012 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3013
3014 applied to:
3015
3016 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3017
3018 outputs:
3019
3020 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3021
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003022 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3023 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3024 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3025 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3026 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3027 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3028 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3029 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3030
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003031 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3032 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3033 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3034 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3035 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3036 another equipment.
3037
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003038 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3039 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3040 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3041 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3042 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3043 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3044 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3045 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3046
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003047 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3048 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3049 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3050 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3051 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3052 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3053 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3054 admin privileges.
3055
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003056 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3057 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3058 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3059 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3060 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3061 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3062 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3063 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3064
3065 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3066 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3067 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3068 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3069 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3070 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3071
3072 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3073 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3074 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3075 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3076 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3077 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3078
3079 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3080 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3081 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3082 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3083 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3084 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3085 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3086 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3087 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3088
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003089 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3090
3091 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3092 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3093 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3094 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003095
3096 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003097 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3098 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3099 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003100
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003101 http-request allow if nagios
3102 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3103 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3104 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003105
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003106 Example:
3107 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003108 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003109
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003110 Example:
3111 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3112 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
3113 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
3114 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3115 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3116 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3117 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3118 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3119 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3120
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003121 Example:
3122 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3123 acl add path /addacl
3124 acl del path /delacl
3125
3126 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3127
3128 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3129 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3130
3131 Example:
3132 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3133 acl setmap path /setmap
3134 acl delmap path /delmap
3135
3136 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3137
3138 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3139 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3140
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003141 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3142 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003143
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003144http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003145 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003146 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3147 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003148 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3149 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3150 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3151 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3152 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
3153 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003154 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003155 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3156
3157 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3158 no | yes | yes | yes
3159
3160 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3161 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3162 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3163 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3164 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3165 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3166
3167 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3168 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3169 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3170 current section.
3171
3172 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3173 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3174 rules are evaluated.
3175
3176 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3177 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3178 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3179 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3180 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3181 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3182 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3183
3184 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3185 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3186 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3187 external users.
3188
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003189 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3190 <name>.
3191
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003192 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3193 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3194 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3195 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3196 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3197 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3198 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3199 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
3200
3201 Example:
3202
3203 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
3204
3205 applied to:
3206
3207 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3208
3209 outputs:
3210
3211 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3212
3213 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
3214
3215 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3216 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3217 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3218 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3219 header.
3220
3221 Example:
3222
3223 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
3224
3225 applied to:
3226
3227 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
3228
3229 outputs:
3230
3231 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
3232
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003233 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3234 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3235 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3236 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3237 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3238 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3239 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3240 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3241
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003242 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3243 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3244 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3245 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3246 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3247 another equipment.
3248
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003249 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3250 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3251 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3252 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3253 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3254 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3255 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3256 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3257
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003258 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3259 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3260 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3261 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3262 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3263 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3264 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3265 admin privileges.
3266
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003267 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3268 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3269 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3270 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3271 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3272 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3273 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3274 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3275
3276 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3277 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3278 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3279 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3280 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3281 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3282
3283 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3284 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3285 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3286 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3287 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3288 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3289
3290 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3291 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3292 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3293 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3294 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3295 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3296 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3297 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3298 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3299
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003300 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3301
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003302 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003303 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3304 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3305 rules.
3306
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003307 Example:
3308 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
3309
3310 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3311
3312 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3313 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3314
3315 Example:
3316 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3317
3318 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3319
3320 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
3321 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
3322
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003323 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3324 ACL usage.
3325
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003326
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003327http-send-name-header [<header>]
3328 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3329
3330 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3331 yes | no | yes | yes
3332
3333 Arguments :
3334
3335 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3336
3337 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3338 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3339 is added with the header string proved.
3340
3341 See also : "server"
3342
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003343id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003344 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3346 no | yes | yes | yes
3347 Arguments : none
3348
3349 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3350 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3351 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003352
3353
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003354ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3355 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3356 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3357 no | yes | yes | yes
3358
3359 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3360 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3361 and running).
3362
3363 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3364 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3365 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003366 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003367 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3368
3369 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3370 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3371
3372 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3373 "unless" condition is met.
3374
3375 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3376
3377
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003378log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003379log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003380no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003381 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3382 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3383 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003384
3385 Prefix :
3386 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3387 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3388 prefix does not allow arguments.
3389
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003390 Arguments :
3391 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3392 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3393 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3394 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3395 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3396 parameter.
3397
3398 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3399 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3400
3401 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3402 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3403 standard syslog port).
3404
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003405 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3406 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3407 standard syslog port).
3408
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003409 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3410 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3411 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3412 appropriately writeable).
3413
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003414 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3415 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3416 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3417 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3418
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003419 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
3420 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
3421 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
3422 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
3423 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
3424 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
3425 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
3426 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
3427 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
3428 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
3429 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
3430
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003431 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3432
3433 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3434 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3435 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3436
3437 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3438 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3439 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003440 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3441 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3442 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3443 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3444 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003445
3446 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3447
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003448 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3449 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3450 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003451
3452 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3453 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3454 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3455 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3456
3457 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3458 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003459
3460 Example :
3461 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003462 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3463 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003464 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3465
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003466
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003467log-format <string>
3468 Allows you to custom a log line.
3469
3470 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
3471
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003472
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003473max-keep-alive-queue <value>
3474 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
3475 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3476 yes | no | yes | yes
3477
3478 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
3479 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
3480 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
3481 servers.
3482
3483 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
3484 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
3485 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
3486 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
3487 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
3488 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
3489 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
3490 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
3491 picking a different server.
3492
3493 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
3494 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
3495 even if they have to be queued.
3496
3497 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
3498 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
3499
3500
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003501maxconn <conns>
3502 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3504 yes | yes | yes | no
3505 Arguments :
3506 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3507 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3508 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3509 closes.
3510
3511 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3512 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3513 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3514 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3515 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3516 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3517 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3518 properly tuned.
3519
3520 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3521 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3522 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3523
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003524 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3525
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003526 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3527
3528
3529mode { tcp|http|health }
3530 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3531 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3532 yes | yes | yes | yes
3533 Arguments :
3534 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3535 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3536 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3537 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3538
3539 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3540 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3541 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3542 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3543 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3544
3545 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003546 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3547 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3548 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3549 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3550 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3551 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3552 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003553
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003554 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3555 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3556 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003557
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003558 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003559 defaults http_instances
3560 mode http
3561
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003562 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003563
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003564
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003565monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003566 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3568 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003569 Arguments :
3570 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3571 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003572 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003573 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3574 backend and its backup.
3575
3576 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3577 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3578 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3579 servers in a list of backends.
3580
3581 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3582 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3583 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3584 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3585 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3586 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3587 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003588 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3589 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003590
3591 Example:
3592 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003593 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003594 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3595 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3596 monitor-uri /site_alive
3597 monitor fail if site_dead
3598
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003599 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003600
3601
3602monitor-net <source>
3603 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3605 yes | yes | yes | no
3606 Arguments :
3607 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3608 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3609 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3610 followed by a mask.
3611
3612 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3613 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003614 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003615 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3616
3617 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3618 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3619 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3620 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003621 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3622 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3623 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003624
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003625 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3626 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3627 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3628 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3629 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3630 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003631
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003632 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3633 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003634
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003635 Example :
3636 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3637 frontend www
3638 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3639
3640 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3641
3642
3643monitor-uri <uri>
3644 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3645 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3646 yes | yes | yes | no
3647 Arguments :
3648 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3649 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3650
3651 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3652 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3653 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3654 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3655 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3656 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3657 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3658 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3659
3660 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3661 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3662 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3663 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3664 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3665 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3666
3667 Example :
3668 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3669 frontend www
3670 mode http
3671 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3672
3673 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3674
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003675
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003676option abortonclose
3677no option abortonclose
3678 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3679 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3680 yes | no | yes | yes
3681 Arguments : none
3682
3683 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3684 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3685 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3686 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003687 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003688 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3689 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3690 encountered while delivering the response.
3691
3692 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3693 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3694 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3695 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3696 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3697 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003698 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003699 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003700 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003701 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3702 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3703 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3704
3705 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3706 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3707 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3708 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3709 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3710 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3711 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3712 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003713 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003714
3715 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3716 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3717
3718 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3719
3720
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003721option accept-invalid-http-request
3722no option accept-invalid-http-request
3723 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3725 yes | yes | yes | no
3726 Arguments : none
3727
3728 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3729 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3730 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3731 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3732 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3733 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3734 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3735 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003736 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3737 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3738 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3739 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3740 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3741 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003742
3743 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3744 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3745 been confirmed.
3746
3747 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3748 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003749 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3750 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003751 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3752
3753 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3754 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3755
3756 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3757 stats socket.
3758
3759
3760option accept-invalid-http-response
3761no option accept-invalid-http-response
3762 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3764 yes | no | yes | yes
3765 Arguments : none
3766
3767 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3768 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3769 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3770 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3771 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3772 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3773 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3774 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3775 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3776
3777 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3778 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3779 been confirmed.
3780
3781 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3782 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3783 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3784 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3785
3786 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3787 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3788
3789 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3790 stats socket.
3791
3792
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003793option allbackups
3794no option allbackups
3795 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3797 yes | no | yes | yes
3798 Arguments : none
3799
3800 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3801 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3802 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3803 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3804 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3805 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3806 order between the backup servers anymore.
3807
3808 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3809 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3810
3811 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3812 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3813
3814
3815option checkcache
3816no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08003817 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003818 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3819 yes | no | yes | yes
3820 Arguments : none
3821
3822 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3823 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003824 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003825 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3826 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003827 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003828
3829 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003830 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003831 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003832 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3833 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003834 to the client are :
3835 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003836 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003837 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003838 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3839 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3840 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3841 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3842 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3843 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3844 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3845 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3846 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3847 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3848 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3849
3850 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003851 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003852 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003853 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003854 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3855
3856 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3857 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003858 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003859 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3860
3861 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3862 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3863
3864
3865option clitcpka
3866no option clitcpka
3867 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3868 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3869 yes | yes | yes | no
3870 Arguments : none
3871
3872 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3873 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3874 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3875 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3876
3877 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3878 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3879 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3880 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3881
3882 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3883 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3884 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3885 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3886 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3887
3888 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3889
3890 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3891 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3892 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3893
3894 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3895 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3896
3897 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3898
3899
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003900option contstats
3901 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3903 yes | yes | yes | no
3904 Arguments : none
3905
3906 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3907 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3908 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3909 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3910 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3911 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3912 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3913
3914
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003915option dontlog-normal
3916no option dontlog-normal
3917 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3918 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3919 yes | yes | yes | no
3920 Arguments : none
3921
3922 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3923 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3924 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3925 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3926 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3927 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3928 logged.
3929
3930 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3931 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3932 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3933
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003934 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003935 logging.
3936
3937
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003938option dontlognull
3939no option dontlognull
3940 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3941 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3942 yes | yes | yes | no
3943 Arguments : none
3944
3945 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3946 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3947 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3948 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3949 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3950 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3951 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3952
3953 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3954 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3955 would not be logged.
3956
3957 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3958 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3959
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003960 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003961
3962
3963option forceclose
3964no option forceclose
3965 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003967 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003968 Arguments : none
3969
3970 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3971 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3972 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3973 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3974 global session times in the logs.
3975
3976 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003977 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003978 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003979
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003980 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3981 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3982 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3983
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003984 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
3985 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01003986
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003987 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3988 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3989
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003990 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003991
3992
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003993option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003994 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3996 yes | yes | yes | yes
3997 Arguments :
3998 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3999 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004000 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004001 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004002
4003 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
4004 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
4005 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
4006 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
4007 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
4008 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
4009 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004010 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
4011 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4012 possible that the client has already brought one.
4013
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004014 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004015 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004016 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
4017 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004018 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
4019 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004020
4021 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4022 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4023 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4024 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4025 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4026 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4027 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4028
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004029 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
4030 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
4031 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
4032 are under the control of the end-user.
4033
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004034 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004035 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4036 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004037 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
4038 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
4039 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004040
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004041 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004042 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
4043 frontend www
4044 mode http
4045 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
4046
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004047 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
4048 backend www
4049 mode http
4050 option forwardfor header X-Client
4051
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004052 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004053 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004054
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004055
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004056option http-keep-alive
4057no option http-keep-alive
4058 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
4059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4060 yes | yes | yes | yes
4061 Arguments : none
4062
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004063 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4064 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4065 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
4066 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
4067 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4068 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
4069 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
4070
4071 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
4072 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004073 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
4074 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
4075 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
4076 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
4077 situations where this option may be useful :
4078
4079 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
4080 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
4081
4082 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
4083 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
4084
4085 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
4086 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
4087 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
4088 request.
4089
4090 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
4091 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004092 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
4093 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
4094 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004095
4096 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
4097 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
4098
4099 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4100 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4101 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4102 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
4103 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4104 not set.
4105
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004106 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4107 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004108 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004109 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004110
4111 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004112 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
4113 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004114
4115
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004116option http-no-delay
4117no option http-no-delay
4118 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
4119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4120 yes | yes | yes | yes
4121 Arguments : none
4122
4123 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
4124 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
4125 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
4126 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
4127 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
4128 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
4129 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
4130 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
4131 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
4132 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
4133 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
4134 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
4135 affected.
4136
4137 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
4138 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
4139 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
4140 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4141 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4142 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4143 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4144 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4145 latency environments.
4146
4147
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004148option http-pretend-keepalive
4149no option http-pretend-keepalive
4150 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4152 yes | yes | yes | yes
4153 Arguments : none
4154
4155 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4156 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4157 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4158 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4159 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4160 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4161 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4162 consider the response complete.
4163
4164 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4165 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4166 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4167 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4168 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4169 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4170
4171 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4172 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4173 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4174 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4175 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4176 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4177 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4178
4179 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4180 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004181 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004182 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4183 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004184
4185 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4186 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4187
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004188 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4189 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004190
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004191
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004192option http-server-close
4193no option http-server-close
4194 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4195 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4196 yes | yes | yes | yes
4197 Arguments : none
4198
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004199 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4200 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4201 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4202 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4203 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4204 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4205 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4206 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4207 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4208 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4209 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4210 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4211 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4212 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4213 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4214 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004215
4216 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4217 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4218 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4219 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004220 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4221 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004222
4223 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4224 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004225 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4226 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004227 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4228 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004229
4230 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4231 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4232
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004233 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004234 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4235 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004236
4237
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004238option http-tunnel
4239no option http-tunnel
4240 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4241 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4242 yes | yes | yes | yes
4243 Arguments : none
4244
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004245 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4246 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4247 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4248 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4249 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4250 "option http-tunnel".
4251
4252 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004253 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004254 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4255 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4256 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4257 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4258 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4259 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4260 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004261
4262 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4263 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4264
4265 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4266 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4267 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4268
4269
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004270option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004271no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004272 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4273 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4274 yes | yes | yes | no
4275 Arguments : none
4276
4277 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4278 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4279 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4280 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4281 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4282 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4283 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4284
4285 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4286 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4287 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4288 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4289 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4290 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4291 request along its whole life.
4292
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004293 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4294 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4295 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4296 front of an existing proxy.
4297
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004298 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4299
4300 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4301 http-server-close".
4302
4303
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004304option httpchk
4305option httpchk <uri>
4306option httpchk <method> <uri>
4307option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4308 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4309 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4310 yes | no | yes | yes
4311 Arguments :
4312 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4313 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4314 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4315 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4316 ones.
4317
4318 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4319 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4320 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4321
4322 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4323 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4324 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4325 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4326 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4327
4328 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4329 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4330 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4331 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4332 the lack of any response.
4333
4334 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4335
4336 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4337 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4338 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4339
4340 Examples :
4341 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4342 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4343 backend https_relay
4344 mode tcp
4345 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4346 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4347
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004348 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4349 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4350 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004351
4352
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004353option httpclose
4354no option httpclose
4355 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4357 yes | yes | yes | yes
4358 Arguments : none
4359
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004360 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4361 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4362 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4363 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004364 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004365 "option http-tunnel".
4366
4367 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
4368 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
4369 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
4370 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
4371 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
4372 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
4373 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
4374 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004375
4376 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004377 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004378 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4379 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4380 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4381 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4382 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004383
4384 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4385 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004386 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
4387 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004388 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
4389 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004390
4391 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4392 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4393
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004394 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4395 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004396
4397
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004398option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004399 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4401 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004402 Arguments :
4403 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4404 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4405 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4406 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4407 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004408
4409 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4410 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4411 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4412 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4413 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4414 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4415 ports.
4416
4417 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4418
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004419 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4420 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
4421 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
4422 by default.
4423
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004424 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004425
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004426
4427option http_proxy
4428no option http_proxy
4429 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4430 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4431 yes | yes | yes | yes
4432 Arguments : none
4433
4434 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4435 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4436 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4437 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4438 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4439
4440 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4441 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4442 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4443 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004444 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004445 be analyzed.
4446
4447 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4448 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4449
4450 Example :
4451 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4452 backend direct_forward
4453 option httpclose
4454 option http_proxy
4455
4456 See also : "option httpclose"
4457
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004458
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004459option independent-streams
4460no option independent-streams
4461 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004462 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4463 yes | yes | yes | yes
4464 Arguments : none
4465
4466 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4467 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4468 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4469 receive data or not.
4470
4471 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4472 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4473 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4474 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4475 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4476 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4477 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4478 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4479 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4480 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4481 socket buffers.
4482
4483 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4484 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4485 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4486 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4487 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4488
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004489 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004490 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4491 deprecated.
4492
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004493 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004494
4495
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004496option ldap-check
4497 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4499 yes | no | yes | yes
4500 Arguments : none
4501
4502 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4503 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4504 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4505 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4506
4507 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4508 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4509
4510 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4511 configure it.
4512
4513 Example :
4514 option ldap-check
4515
4516 See also : "option httpchk"
4517
4518
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09004519option external-check
4520 Use external processes for server health checks
4521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4522 yes | no | yes | yes
4523
4524 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
4525 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
4526 command".
4527
4528 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
4529
4530 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
4531
4532
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004533option log-health-checks
4534no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004535 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004536 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4537 yes | no | yes | yes
4538 Arguments : none
4539
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004540 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
4541 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
4542 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004543
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004544 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
4545 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
4546 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
4547 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
4548 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
4549
4550 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
4551 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004552
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004553 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
4554 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
4555 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004556
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004557
4558option log-separate-errors
4559no option log-separate-errors
4560 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4561 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4562 yes | yes | yes | no
4563 Arguments : none
4564
4565 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4566 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4567 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4568 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4569 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4570 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4571 provides very important information.
4572
4573 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4574 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4575 error logs.
4576
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004577 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004578 logging.
4579
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004580
4581option logasap
4582no option logasap
4583 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4584 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4585 yes | yes | yes | no
4586 Arguments : none
4587
4588 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4589 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4590 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4591 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4592 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4593 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4594 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004595 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004596 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4597 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4598
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004599 Examples :
4600 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4601 mode http
4602 option httplog
4603 option logasap
4604 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4605
4606 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4607 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4608 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4609 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4610
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004611 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004612 logging.
4613
4614
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004615option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004616 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4618 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004619 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004620 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4621 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004622 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004623
4624 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4625 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4626 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4627 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4628 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4629 in the MySQL table, like this :
4630
4631 USE mysql;
4632 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4633 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4634
4635 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4636 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4637 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4638 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4639 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4640 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4641 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4642 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4643 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4644
4645 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4646 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004647
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004648 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004649
4650 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4651 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4652 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4653 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4654 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4655 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4656
4657 See also: "option httpchk"
4658
4659
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004660option nolinger
4661no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004662 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004663 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4664 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004665 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004666
4667 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4668 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4669 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4670 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4671 connections.
4672
4673 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4674 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4675 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4676 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4677 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4678 this too.
4679
4680 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4681 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4682 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4683
4684 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4685 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4686 for servers.
4687
4688 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4689 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4690
4691
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004692option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4693 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4694 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4695 yes | yes | yes | yes
4696 Arguments :
4697 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4698 matching <network>
4699 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4700 header name.
4701
4702 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4703 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4704 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4705 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4706 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4707 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4708 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4709 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4710 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4711 possible that the client has already brought one.
4712
4713 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4714 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4715 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4716 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4717 header and requires different one.
4718
4719 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4720 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4721 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4722 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4723 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4724 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4725 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4726
4727 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4728 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4729 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4730 both are defined.
4731
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004732 Examples :
4733 # Original Destination address
4734 frontend www
4735 mode http
4736 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4737
4738 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4739 backend www
4740 mode http
4741 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4742
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004743 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4744 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004745
4746
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004747option persist
4748no option persist
4749 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4750 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4751 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004752 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004753
4754 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4755 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4756 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4757 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4758 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4759 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4760 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4761 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4762 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4763 redirected to another valid server.
4764
4765 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4766 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4767
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004768 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004769
4770
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01004771option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4772 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4774 yes | no | yes | yes
4775 Arguments :
4776 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4777 PostgreSQL server.
4778
4779 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4780 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4781 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4782 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4783
4784 See also: "option httpchk"
4785
4786
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004787option prefer-last-server
4788no option prefer-last-server
4789 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
4790 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4791 yes | no | yes | yes
4792 Arguments : none
4793
4794 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
4795 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
4796 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
4797 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
4798 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
4799 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
4800 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
4801 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
4802 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01004803 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
4804 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
4805 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
4806 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
4807 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
4808 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
4809 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004810
4811 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4812 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4813
4814 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
4815
4816
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004817option redispatch
4818no option redispatch
4819 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4820 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4821 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004822 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004823
4824 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4825 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4826 be able to access the service anymore.
4827
4828 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4829 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4830
4831 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4832 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4833 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004834
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004835 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4836 "redisp" keywords.
4837
4838 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4839 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4840
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004841 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004842
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004843
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004844option redis-check
4845 Use redis health checks for server testing
4846 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4847 yes | no | yes | yes
4848 Arguments : none
4849
4850 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4851 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4852 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4853 find the "+PONG" response message.
4854
4855 Example :
4856 option redis-check
4857
4858 See also : "option httpchk"
4859
4860
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004861option smtpchk
4862option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4863 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4864 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4865 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004866 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004867 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4868 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4869 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4870
4871 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4872 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4873 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4874
4875 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4876 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4877 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4878 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4879 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4880 dead server.
4881
4882 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4883 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4884 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4885 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4886
4887 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4888 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4889 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4890 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4891 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4892
4893 Example :
4894 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4895
4896 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4897
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004898
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004899option socket-stats
4900no option socket-stats
4901
4902 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4904 yes | yes | yes | no
4905
4906 Arguments : none
4907
4908
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004909option splice-auto
4910no option splice-auto
4911 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4912 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4913 yes | yes | yes | yes
4914 Arguments : none
4915
4916 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4917 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4918 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4919 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004920 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004921 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4922 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4923 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4924 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4925
4926 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4927 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4928 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4929 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4930 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4931 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4932 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4933 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4934 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4935 keyword.
4936
4937 Example :
4938 option splice-auto
4939
4940 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4941 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4942
4943 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4944 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4945
4946
4947option splice-request
4948no option splice-request
4949 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4951 yes | yes | yes | yes
4952 Arguments : none
4953
4954 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004955 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004956 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4957 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4958 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4959 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4960
4961 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4962
4963 Example :
4964 option splice-request
4965
4966 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4967 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4968
4969 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4970 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4971
4972
4973option splice-response
4974no option splice-response
4975 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4977 yes | yes | yes | yes
4978 Arguments : none
4979
4980 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004981 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004982 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4983 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4984 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4985 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4986
4987 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4988
4989 Example :
4990 option splice-response
4991
4992 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4993 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4994
4995 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4996 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4997
4998
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004999option srvtcpka
5000no option srvtcpka
5001 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
5002 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5003 yes | no | yes | yes
5004 Arguments : none
5005
5006 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5007 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5008 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5009 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5010
5011 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5012 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5013 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5014 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5015
5016 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5017 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5018 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5019 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5020 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5021
5022 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5023
5024 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5025 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5026 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
5027
5028 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5029 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5030
5031 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
5032
5033
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005034option ssl-hello-chk
5035 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
5036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5037 yes | no | yes | yes
5038 Arguments : none
5039
5040 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
5041 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
5042 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
5043 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
5044 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
5045 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
5046 hello message.
5047
5048 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
5049 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
5050 messages, which is appreciable.
5051
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005052 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
5053 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
5054 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005055
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005056 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
5057
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005058
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005059option tcp-check
5060 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
5061 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5062 yes | no | yes | yes
5063
5064 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
5065 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
5066
5067 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
5068 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
5069 attempt, which remains the default mode.
5070
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005071 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005072 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
5073 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
5074 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
5075 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
5076 only.
5077
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005078 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005079 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
5080 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
5081 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
5082 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
5083
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005084 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005085 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
5086 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005087 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005088 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
5089 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
5090 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
5091 the respective protocols.
5092 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
5093 analysed.
5094
5095 Examples :
5096 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
5097 option tcp-check
5098 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
5099
5100 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
5101 option tcp-check
5102 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
5103
5104 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
5105 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005106 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005107 option tcp-check
5108 tcp-check send PING\r\n
5109 tcp-check expect +PONG
5110 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
5111 tcp-check expect string role:master
5112 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
5113 tcp-check expect string +OK
5114
5115 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
5116 (send many headers before analyzing)
5117 option tcp-check
5118 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
5119 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
5120 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
5121 tcp-check send \r\n
5122 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
5123
5124
5125 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
5126
5127
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005128option tcp-smart-accept
5129no option tcp-smart-accept
5130 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
5131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5132 yes | yes | yes | no
5133 Arguments : none
5134
5135 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
5136 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
5137 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
5138 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
5139 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
5140 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
5141
5142 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
5143 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
5144 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
5145 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
5146
5147 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
5148 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
5149 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
5150 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
5151
5152 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
5153 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
5154 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
5155
5156 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
5157 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
5158 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
5159
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02005160 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
5161
5162
5163option tcp-smart-connect
5164no option tcp-smart-connect
5165 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5166 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5167 yes | no | yes | yes
5168 Arguments : none
5169
5170 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5171 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5172 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5173 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5174 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5175
5176 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5177 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5178 complex.
5179
5180 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5181 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5182 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5183
5184 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5185 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5186
5187 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5188
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005189
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005190option tcpka
5191 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5192 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5193 yes | yes | yes | yes
5194 Arguments : none
5195
5196 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5197 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5198 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5199 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5200
5201 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5202 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5203 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5204 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5205
5206 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5207 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5208 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5209 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5210 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5211
5212 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5213
5214 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5215 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5216 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5217 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5218 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5219 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5220 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5221 backends.
5222
5223 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5224
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005225
5226option tcplog
5227 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5228 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5229 yes | yes | yes | yes
5230 Arguments : none
5231
5232 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5233 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5234 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5235 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5236 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5237 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5238 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5239 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5240
5241 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5242
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005243 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005244
5245
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005246option transparent
5247no option transparent
5248 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5249 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005250 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005251 Arguments : none
5252
5253 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5254 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5255 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5256 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5257 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5258 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5259 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5260 appropriate server.
5261
5262 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5263 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5264
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01005265 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005266 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005267
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005268
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005269external-check command <command>
5270 Executable to run when performing an external-check
5271 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5272 yes | no | yes | yes
5273
5274 Arguments :
5275 <command> is the external command to run
5276
5277 The PATH environment variable used when executing the
5278 command may be set using "external-check path".
5279
5280 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
5281
5282 proxy_address proxy_port server_address server_port
5283
5284 The proxy_address and proxy_port are derived from the first listener
5285 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. It is an error for no such
5286 listeners to exist. In the case of a UNIX socket listener the
5287 proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the proxy_port will
5288 be the string "NOT_USED".
5289
5290 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
5291 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
5292 failed.
5293
5294 Example :
5295 external-check command /bin/true
5296
5297 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
5298
5299
5300external-check path <path>
5301 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
5302 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5303 yes | no | yes | yes
5304
5305 Arguments :
5306 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
5307
5308 The default path is "".
5309
5310 Example :
5311 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
5312
5313 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
5314 "external-check command"
5315
5316
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005317persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005318persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005319 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
5320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5321 yes | no | yes | yes
5322 Arguments :
5323 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005324 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
5325 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005326
5327 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
5328 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
5329 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
5330 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
5331 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
5332 forwarded to this server.
5333
5334 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
5335 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
5336 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005337 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005338 a single "listen" section.
5339
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005340 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
5341 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
5342 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
5343
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005344 Example :
5345 listen tse-farm
5346 bind :3389
5347 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
5348 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5349 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
5350 # apply RDP cookie persistence
5351 persist rdp-cookie
5352 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005353 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005354 balance rdp-cookie
5355 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
5356 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
5357
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09005358 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
5359 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005360
5361
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005362rate-limit sessions <rate>
5363 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
5364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5365 yes | yes | yes | no
5366 Arguments :
5367 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
5368 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
5369
5370 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
5371 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
5372 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
5373 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
5374 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
5375 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
5376
5377 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
5378 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
5379 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
5380 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
5381
5382 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
5383 listen smtp
5384 mode tcp
5385 bind :25
5386 rate-limit sessions 10
5387 server 127.0.0.1:1025
5388
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02005389 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
5390 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5391 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005392
5393 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5394
5395
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005396redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5397redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5398redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005399 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5401 no | yes | yes | yes
5402
5403 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005404 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005405
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005406 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005407 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005408 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5409 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5410 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005411
5412 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5413 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5414 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5415 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5416 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005417 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5418 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5419 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5420 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005421
5422 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5423 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5424 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5425 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5426 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5427 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005428 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005429 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005430 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5431 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5432 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005433
5434 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005435 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5436 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5437 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5438 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5439 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5440 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5441 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5442 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005443
5444 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5445 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5446
5447 - "drop-query"
5448 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5449 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5450 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5451 with a location-type redirect.
5452
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005453 - "append-slash"
5454 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5455 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5456 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5457 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5458
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005459 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5460 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5461 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5462 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5463 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5464 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5465 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5466
5467 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5468 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5469 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5470 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5471 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5472 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5473 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005474
5475 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5476 acl clear dst_port 80
5477 acl secure dst_port 8080
5478 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005479 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005480 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005481 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5482
5483 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005484 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5485 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5486 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005487 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005488
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005489 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5490 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5491 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5492
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005493 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005494 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005495
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005496 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5497 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5498 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5499
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005500 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005501
5502
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005503redisp (deprecated)
5504redispatch (deprecated)
5505 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5506 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5507 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005508 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005509
5510 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5511 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5512 be able to access the service anymore.
5513
5514 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5515 redistribute them to a working server.
5516
5517 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5518 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5519 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005520
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005521 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5522 "option redispatch" instead.
5523
5524 See also : "option redispatch"
5525
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005526
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005527reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005528 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5529 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5530 no | yes | yes | yes
5531 Arguments :
5532 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5533 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005534 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005535
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005536 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5537 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5538
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005539 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5540 the last header of an HTTP request.
5541
5542 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5543 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5544 responses.
5545
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005546 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
5547 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
5548 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
5549
5550 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5551 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005552
5553
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005554reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5555reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005556 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5557 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5558 no | yes | yes | yes
5559 Arguments :
5560 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5561 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5562 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5563 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5564 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5565 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
5566 ignores case.
5567
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005568 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5569 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5570
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005571 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5572 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
5573 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5574 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005575 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005576
5577 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5578 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5579
5580 Example :
5581 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
5582 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5583 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5584
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005585 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
5586 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005587
5588
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005589reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5590reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005591 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
5592 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5593 no | yes | yes | yes
5594 Arguments :
5595 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5596 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5597 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5598 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5599 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
5600 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
5601
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005602 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5603 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5604
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005605 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
5606 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
5607 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
5608 next servers.
5609
5610 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5611 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5612 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5613
5614 Example :
5615 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
5616 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
5617 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
5618
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005619 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5620 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005621
5622
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005623reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5624reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005625 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5626 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5627 no | yes | yes | yes
5628 Arguments :
5629 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5630 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5631 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5632 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5633 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5634 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
5635 case.
5636
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005637 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5638 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5639
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005640 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5641 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
5642 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5643 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005644 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005645
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005646 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005647 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005648 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005649
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005650 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5651 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5652
5653 Example :
5654 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
5655 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5656 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5657
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005658 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5659 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005660
5661
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005662reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5663reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005664 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
5665 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5666 no | yes | yes | yes
5667 Arguments :
5668 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5669 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5670 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5671 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5672 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5673 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
5674 case.
5675
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005676 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5677 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5678
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005679 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5680 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
5681 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
5682 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5683
5684 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5685 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5686
5687 Example :
5688 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
5689 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
5690 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5691 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5692
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005693 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5694 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005695
5696
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005697reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5698reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005699 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
5700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5701 no | yes | yes | yes
5702 Arguments :
5703 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5704 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5705 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5706 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5707 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
5708 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
5709
5710 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5711 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5712 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5713 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005714 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005715
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005716 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5717 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5718
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005719 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
5720 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5721 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5722
5723 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5724 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5725 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5726 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5727 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5728
5729 Example :
5730 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005731 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005732 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5733 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5734
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005735 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5736 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005737
5738
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005739reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5740reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005741 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5742 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5743 no | yes | yes | yes
5744 Arguments :
5745 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5746 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5747 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5748 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5749 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5750 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5751 ignores case.
5752
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005753 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5754 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5755
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005756 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5757 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005758 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5759 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5760 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005761 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5762 not set.
5763
5764 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5765 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5766 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5767 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5768 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5769
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005770 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005771 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5772 # block all others.
5773 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5774 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5775
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005776 # block bad guys
5777 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5778 reqitarpit . if badguys
5779
5780 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5781 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005782
5783
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005784retries <value>
5785 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5786 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5787 yes | no | yes | yes
5788 Arguments :
5789 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5790 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5791 default value is 3.
5792
5793 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5794 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5795 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5796
5797 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5798 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5799
5800 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5801 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5802
5803 See also : "option redispatch"
5804
5805
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005806rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005807 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5808 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5809 no | yes | yes | yes
5810 Arguments :
5811 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5812 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005813 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005814
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005815 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5816 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5817
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005818 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5819 the last header of an HTTP response.
5820
5821 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5822 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5823 responses.
5824
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005825 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5826 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005827
5828
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005829rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5830rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005831 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5833 no | yes | yes | yes
5834 Arguments :
5835 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5836 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5837 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5838 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5839 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5840 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5841 ignores case.
5842
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005843 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5844 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5845
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005846 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5847 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005848 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005849 client.
5850
5851 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5852 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5853 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5854
5855 Example :
5856 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02005857 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005858
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005859 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5860 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005861
5862
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005863rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5864rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005865 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
5866 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5867 no | yes | yes | yes
5868 Arguments :
5869 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5870 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5871 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5872 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5873 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5874 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
5875 ignores case.
5876
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005877 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5878 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5879
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005880 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5881 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
5882 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
5883 case-sensitive.
5884
5885 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005886 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
5887 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
5888 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005889
5890 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5891 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
5892
5893 Example :
5894 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
5895 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
5896
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005897 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
5898 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005899
5900
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005901rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5902rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005903 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5904 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5905 no | yes | yes | yes
5906 Arguments :
5907 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5908 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5909 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5910 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5911 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5912 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5913 ignores case.
5914
5915 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5916 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5917 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5918 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005919 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005920
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005921 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5922 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5923
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005924 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5925 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5926 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5927
5928 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5929 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5930 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5931 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5932 are not case-sensitive.
5933
5934 Example :
5935 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
5936 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
5937
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005938 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
5939 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005940
5941
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005942server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005943 Declare a server in a backend
5944 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5945 no | no | yes | yes
5946 Arguments :
5947 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02005948 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005949 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005950
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005951 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
5952 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5953 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
5954 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02005955 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
5956 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
5957 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
5958 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
5959 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005960 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
5961 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
5962 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
5963 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5964 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5965 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5966 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02005967 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005968 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5969 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5970 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5971 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005972
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005973 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005974 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
5975 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
5976 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
5977 adding this value to the client's port.
5978
5979 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
5980 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005981 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005982
5983 Examples :
5984 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
5985 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005986 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005987 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
5988 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
5989 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005990
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005991 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
5992 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005993
5994
5995source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005996source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005997source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005998 Set the source address for outgoing connections
5999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6000 yes | no | yes | yes
6001 Arguments :
6002 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
6003 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006004
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006005 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006006 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
6007 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
6008 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
6009 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
6010 supported prefixes are :
6011 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6012 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6013 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006014 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006015 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
6016 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
6017 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
6018 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006019
6020 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
6021 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006022 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
6023 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
6024 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006025
6026 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
6027 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
6028 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
6029 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
6030 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
6031 <addr>.
6032
6033 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
6034 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
6035 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
6036 port.
6037
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006038 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
6039 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
6040 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
6041 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01006042 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006043 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
6044 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
6045 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
6046 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
6047 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
6048 HTTP header.
6049
6050 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
6051 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006052 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006053 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
6054 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
6055 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
6056 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
6057 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
6058 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
6059 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
6060
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006061 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
6062 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
6063 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
6064 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
6065 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
6066 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
6067
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006068 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
6069 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
6070 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
6071 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
6072
6073 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
6074 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
6075 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
6076 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
6077 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
6078 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
6079
6080 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
6081 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
6082 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
6083 there are two methods :
6084
6085 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
6086 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
6087 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
6088 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
6089 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
6090 of the client ranges may be used.
6091
6092 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
6093 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
6094 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
6095 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
6096 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
6097 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
6098 same session.
6099
6100 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
6101 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
6102 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
6103 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
6104 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
6105 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
6106
6107 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
6108 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
6109 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006110 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006111
6112 Examples :
6113 backend private
6114 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
6115 source 192.168.1.200
6116
6117 backend transparent_ssl1
6118 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
6119 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6120
6121 backend transparent_ssl2
6122 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
6123 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
6124 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
6125
6126 backend transparent_ssl3
6127 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
6128 # is more conntrack-friendly.
6129 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6130
6131 backend transparent_smtp
6132 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
6133 # with Tproxy version 4.
6134 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
6135
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006136 backend transparent_http
6137 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
6138 # proxy.
6139 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
6140
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006141 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006142 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
6143
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006144
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006145srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6146 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6147 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6148 yes | no | yes | yes
6149 Arguments :
6150 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6151 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6152 as explained at the top of this document.
6153
6154 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6155 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6156 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6157 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6158 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6159 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6160 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6161
6162 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6163 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6164 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6165 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6166 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006167 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006168 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006169 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006170
6171 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6172 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6173 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6174 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6175 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6176 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6177
6178 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
6179 Please use "timeout server" instead.
6180
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006181 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
6182 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006183
6184
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006185stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
6186 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
6187 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006188 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006189
6190 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
6191 matched.
6192
6193 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
6194 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
6195
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006196 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6197 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6198 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6199
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01006200 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
6201 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
6202 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
6203 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006204
6205 Example :
6206 # statistics admin level only for localhost
6207 backend stats_localhost
6208 stats enable
6209 stats admin if LOCALHOST
6210
6211 Example :
6212 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
6213 backend stats_auth
6214 stats enable
6215 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
6216 stats admin if TRUE
6217
6218 Example :
6219 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6220 userlist stats-auth
6221 group admin users admin
6222 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6223 group readonly users haproxy
6224 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6225
6226 backend stats_auth
6227 stats enable
6228 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
6229 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
6230 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6231 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6232
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006233 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6234 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6235 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006236
6237
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006238stats auth <user>:<passwd>
6239 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
6240 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006241 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006242 Arguments :
6243 <user> is a user name to grant access to
6244
6245 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
6246
6247 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
6248 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
6249 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
6250 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
6251 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
6252 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
6253
6254 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
6255 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
6256 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006257 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006258
6259 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
6260 report using "stats scope".
6261
6262 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6263 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6264 unobvious parameters.
6265
6266 Example :
6267 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6268 backend public_www
6269 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6270 stats enable
6271 stats hide-version
6272 stats scope .
6273 stats uri /admin?stats
6274 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6275 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6276 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6277
6278 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6279 backend private_monitoring
6280 stats enable
6281 stats uri /admin?stats
6282 stats refresh 5s
6283
6284 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
6285
6286
6287stats enable
6288 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
6289 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006290 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006291 Arguments : none
6292
6293 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
6294 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
6295 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
6296 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
6297 - stats auth : no authentication
6298 - stats scope : no restriction
6299
6300 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6301 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6302 unobvious parameters.
6303
6304 Example :
6305 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6306 backend public_www
6307 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6308 stats enable
6309 stats hide-version
6310 stats scope .
6311 stats uri /admin?stats
6312 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6313 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6314 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6315
6316 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6317 backend private_monitoring
6318 stats enable
6319 stats uri /admin?stats
6320 stats refresh 5s
6321
6322 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6323
6324
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006325stats hide-version
6326 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006327 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006328 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006329 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006330
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006331 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
6332 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
6333 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
6334 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
6335 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
6336 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006337
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006338 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6339 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6340 unobvious parameters.
6341
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006342 Example :
6343 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6344 backend public_www
6345 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006346 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006347 stats hide-version
6348 stats scope .
6349 stats uri /admin?stats
6350 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6351 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6352 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006353
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006354 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6355 backend private_monitoring
6356 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006357 stats uri /admin?stats
6358 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01006359
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006360 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006361
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006362
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02006363stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
6364 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6365 Access control for statistics
6366
6367 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6368 no | no | yes | yes
6369
6370 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
6371 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
6372 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
6373 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
6374 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
6375 should be asked to enter a username and password.
6376
6377 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
6378 instance.
6379
6380 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6381 about ACL usage.
6382
6383
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006384stats realm <realm>
6385 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
6386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006387 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006388 Arguments :
6389 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
6390 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
6391 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
6392
6393 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6394 using a backslash ('\').
6395
6396 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6397 only related to authentication.
6398
6399 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6400 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6401 unobvious parameters.
6402
6403 Example :
6404 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6405 backend public_www
6406 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6407 stats enable
6408 stats hide-version
6409 stats scope .
6410 stats uri /admin?stats
6411 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6412 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6413 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6414
6415 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6416 backend private_monitoring
6417 stats enable
6418 stats uri /admin?stats
6419 stats refresh 5s
6420
6421 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6422
6423
6424stats refresh <delay>
6425 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6426 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006427 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006428 Arguments :
6429 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6430 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6431 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6432 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6433 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6434 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6435
6436 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6437 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6438 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6439 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6440
6441 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6442 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6443 unobvious parameters.
6444
6445 Example :
6446 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6447 backend public_www
6448 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6449 stats enable
6450 stats hide-version
6451 stats scope .
6452 stats uri /admin?stats
6453 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6454 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6455 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6456
6457 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6458 backend private_monitoring
6459 stats enable
6460 stats uri /admin?stats
6461 stats refresh 5s
6462
6463 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6464
6465
6466stats scope { <name> | "." }
6467 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6468 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006469 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006470 Arguments :
6471 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6472 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6473 section in which the statement appears.
6474
6475 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6476 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6477 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6478 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6479 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6480 exists.
6481
6482 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6483 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6484 unobvious parameters.
6485
6486 Example :
6487 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6488 backend public_www
6489 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6490 stats enable
6491 stats hide-version
6492 stats scope .
6493 stats uri /admin?stats
6494 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6495 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6496 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6497
6498 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6499 backend private_monitoring
6500 stats enable
6501 stats uri /admin?stats
6502 stats refresh 5s
6503
6504 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6505
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006506
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006507stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006508 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6509 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006510 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006511
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006512 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006513 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6514
6515 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6516 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6517
6518 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6519 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006520 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006521
6522 Example :
6523 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6524 backend private_monitoring
6525 stats enable
6526 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6527 stats uri /admin?stats
6528 stats refresh 5s
6529
6530 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6531 global section.
6532
6533
6534stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006535 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
6536 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6537 yes | yes | yes | yes
6538 Arguments : none
6539
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006540 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006541 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
6542 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
6543 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
6544 - IP (socket, server)
6545 - cookie (backend, server)
6546
6547 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6548 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006549 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006550
6551 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
6552
6553
6554stats show-node [ <name> ]
6555 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
6556 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006557 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006558 Arguments:
6559 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
6560 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
6561
6562 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6563 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006564 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006565
6566 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6567 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6568 unobvious parameters.
6569
6570 Example:
6571 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6572 backend private_monitoring
6573 stats enable
6574 stats show-node Europe-1
6575 stats uri /admin?stats
6576 stats refresh 5s
6577
6578 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
6579 section.
6580
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006581
6582stats uri <prefix>
6583 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
6584 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006585 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006586 Arguments :
6587 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
6588 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
6589 query string.
6590
6591 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
6592 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
6593 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
6594 possible to reach it in the application.
6595
6596 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006597 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006598 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
6599 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
6600 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
6601 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
6602
6603 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
6604 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
6605 an address or a port to statistics only.
6606
6607 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6608 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6609 unobvious parameters.
6610
6611 Example :
6612 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6613 backend public_www
6614 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6615 stats enable
6616 stats hide-version
6617 stats scope .
6618 stats uri /admin?stats
6619 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6620 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6621 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6622
6623 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6624 backend private_monitoring
6625 stats enable
6626 stats uri /admin?stats
6627 stats refresh 5s
6628
6629 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
6630
6631
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006632stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
6633 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006634 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006635 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006636
6637 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006638 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006639 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6640 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
6641 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
6642
6643 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6644 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6645 the "stick-table" statement.
6646
6647 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
6648 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
6649 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
6650 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
6651 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
6652
6653 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6654 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
6655 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
6656 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
6657 transformation rules.
6658
6659 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6660 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6661 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6662 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6663 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6664 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6665 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6666
6667 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
6668 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
6669 ACL based conditions.
6670
6671 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
6672 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
6673 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
6674 matches can be used as fallbacks.
6675
6676 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
6677 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
6678 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
6679 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
6680
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006681 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6682 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6683 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6684
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006685 Example :
6686 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6687 # last 30 minutes
6688 backend pop
6689 mode tcp
6690 balance roundrobin
6691 stick store-request src
6692 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6693 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6694 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6695
6696 backend smtp
6697 mode tcp
6698 balance roundrobin
6699 stick match src table pop
6700 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6701 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6702
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006703 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006704 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006705
6706
6707stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6708 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
6709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6710 no | no | yes | yes
6711
6712 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
6713 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
6714 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
6715 for writing more maintainable configurations.
6716
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006717 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6718 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6719 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6720
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006721 Examples :
6722 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01006723 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006724
6725 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
6726 stick match src table pop if !localhost
6727 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6728
6729
6730 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6731 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6732 backend http
6733 mode http
6734 balance roundrobin
6735 stick on src table https
6736 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6737 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6738 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6739
6740 backend https
6741 mode tcp
6742 balance roundrobin
6743 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6744 stick on src
6745 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6746 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6747
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006748 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006749
6750
6751stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6752 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6753 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6754 no | no | yes | yes
6755
6756 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006757 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006758 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6759 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6760 server is selected.
6761
6762 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6763 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6764 the "stick-table" statement.
6765
6766 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6767 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6768 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6769 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6770 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6771 address.
6772
6773 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6774 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6775 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6776 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6777 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6778 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6779 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6780 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6781 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6782 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6783
6784 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6785 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6786 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6787 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6788 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6789 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6790 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6791
6792 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6793 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6794 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6795 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6796
6797 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6798 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6799 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6800 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6801 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6802 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006803 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
6804 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6805 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6806 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6807 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6808 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006809
6810 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6811 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6812 the request.
6813
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006814 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6815 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6816 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6817
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006818 Example :
6819 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6820 # last 30 minutes
6821 backend pop
6822 mode tcp
6823 balance roundrobin
6824 stick store-request src
6825 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6826 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6827 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6828
6829 backend smtp
6830 mode tcp
6831 balance roundrobin
6832 stick match src table pop
6833 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6834 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6835
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006836 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006837 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006838
6839
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006840stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006841 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6842 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08006843 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006845 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006846
6847 Arguments :
6848 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6849 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6850 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6851 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6852
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01006853 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
6854 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
6855 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6856 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6857
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006858 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
6859 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
6860 instance.
6861
6862 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
6863 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
6864 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6865 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
6866 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
6867 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006868 to 32 characters.
6869
6870 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
6871 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
6872 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006873 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006874 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
6875 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006876
6877 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006878 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
6879 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006880 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
6881 increase.
6882
6883 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006884 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
6885 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
6886 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006887
6888 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
6889 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
6890 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
6891 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
6892 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
6893 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
6894 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
6895 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
6896 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
6897 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
6898 parameter (see below).
6899
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006900 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
6901 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
6902 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
6903 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
6904 soft restart.
6905
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006906 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
6907
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006908 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
6909 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
6910 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
6911 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
6912 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006913 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006914 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
6915 if not expiration delay is specified.
6916
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006917 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
6918 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
6919 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
6920 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006921 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
6922 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
6923 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
6924 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
6925 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
6926 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
6927 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
6928 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
6929 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
6930 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
6931 types and their arguments.
6932
6933 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
6934 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
6935 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
6936 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
6937
6938 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
6939 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
6940 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
6941 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
6942
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02006943 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
6944 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
6945 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
6946 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
6947 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
6948 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
6949
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006950 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6951 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
6952 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
6953 they were received.
6954
6955 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6956 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
6957 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
6958 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
6959 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
6960
6961 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6962 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6963 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6964 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
6965 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6966
6967 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6968 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
6969 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
6970
6971 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6972 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6973 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6974 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
6975 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6976
6977 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6978 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
6979 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
6980 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
6981 the client side.
6982
6983 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6984 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6985 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6986 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
6987 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
6988 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
6989 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
6990
6991 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6992 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
6993 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
6994 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
6995 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
6996 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
6997 (eg: vulnerability scan).
6998
6999 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7000 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7001 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7002 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
7003 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
7004 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7005
7006 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7007 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
7008 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
7009 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
7010
7011 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7012 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7013 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7014 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7015 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7016 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
7017 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
7018 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
7019 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
7020 recommended for better fairness.
7021
7022 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7023 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
7024 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
7025 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
7026
7027 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
7028 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7029 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7030 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7031 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7032 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
7033 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
7034 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
7035 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
7036 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007037
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007038 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
7039 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007040 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
7041 reference it.
7042
7043 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
7044 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
7045 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
7046 as an exclusive stickiness.
7047
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007048 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
7049 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
7050 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
7051 something that can be ignored.
7052
7053 Example:
7054 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
7055 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
7056 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
7057 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
7058
7059 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01007060 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007061
7062
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007063stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7064 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7065 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7066 no | no | yes | yes
7067
7068 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007069 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007070 describes what elements of the response or connection will
7071 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7072 server is selected.
7073
7074 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7075 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7076 the "stick-table" statement.
7077
7078 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7079 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7080 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
7081 when the response is a SSL server hello.
7082
7083 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7084 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
7085 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
7086 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
7087 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
7088 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007089 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007090 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
7091 rules.
7092
7093 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7094 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7095 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7096 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7097 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7098 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7099 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7100
7101 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
7102 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7103 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
7104 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7105
7106 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
7107 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7108 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7109 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7110 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7111 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007112 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
7113 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7114 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7115 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7116 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7117 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
7118 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
7119 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
7120 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007121
7122 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
7123
7124 Example :
7125 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
7126 backend https
7127 mode tcp
7128 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007129 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007130 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007131
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007132 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
7133 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
7134
7135 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
7136 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7137 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
7138
7139 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
7140 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007141
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007142 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
7143 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
7144 # at offset 44.
7145
7146 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
7147 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
7148
7149 # Learn on response if server hello.
7150 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007151
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007152 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7153 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7154
7155 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
7156 extraction.
7157
7158
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02007159tcp-check connect [params*]
7160 Opens a new connection
7161 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7162 no | no | yes | yes
7163
7164 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
7165 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
7166 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
7167
7168 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
7169 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
7170 of the sequence.
7171
7172 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
7173 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
7174 do.
7175
7176 Parameters :
7177 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
7178 use the TCP connection.
7179
7180 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
7181 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
7182 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
7183
7184 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
7185
7186 ssl opens a ciphered connection
7187
7188 Examples:
7189 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
7190 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
7191 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
7192 option tcp-check
7193 tcp-check connect
7194 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7195 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7196 tcp-check send \r\n
7197 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7198 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
7199 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7200 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7201 tcp-check send \r\n
7202 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7203 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
7204
7205 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
7206 option tcp-check
7207 tcp-check connect port 110
7208 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7209 tcp-check connect port 143
7210 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7211 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
7212
7213 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
7214
7215
7216tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
7217 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
7218 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7219 no | no | yes | yes
7220
7221 Arguments :
7222 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
7223 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
7224 binary.
7225 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
7226 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
7227 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
7228
7229 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
7230 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
7231 with the usual backslash ('\').
7232 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
7233 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
7234 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
7235 used upper or lower case.
7236
7237
7238 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
7239
7240 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
7241 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7242 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
7243 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7244 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
7245 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
7246 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
7247 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
7248
7249 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
7250 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7251 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
7252 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7253 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
7254 expression.
7255
7256 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
7257 in the response buffer. A health check response will
7258 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
7259 this exact hexadecimal string.
7260 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
7261
7262 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
7263 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
7264 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
7265 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
7266 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
7267 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
7268 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
7269 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
7270 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
7271 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
7272 the null character.
7273
7274 Examples :
7275 # perform a POP check
7276 option tcp-check
7277 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7278
7279 # perform an IMAP check
7280 option tcp-check
7281 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7282
7283 # look for the redis master server
7284 option tcp-check
7285 tcp-check send PING\r\n
7286 tcp-check expect +PONG
7287 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7288 tcp-check expect string role:master
7289 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7290 tcp-check expect string +OK
7291
7292
7293 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
7294 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
7295
7296
7297tcp-check send <data>
7298 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7299 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7300 no | no | yes | yes
7301
7302 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7303 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7304
7305 Examples :
7306 # look for the redis master server
7307 option tcp-check
7308 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7309 tcp-check expect string role:master
7310
7311 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7312 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
7313
7314
7315tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
7316 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
7317 tcp health check
7318 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7319 no | no | yes | yes
7320
7321 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7322 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7323 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
7324 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
7325 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
7326 hexadecimal string.
7327 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
7328
7329 Examples :
7330 # redis check in binary
7331 option tcp-check
7332 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
7333 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
7334
7335
7336 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7337 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
7338
7339
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007340tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7341 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7343 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007344 Arguments :
7345 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007346 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7347 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007348
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007349 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007350
7351 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
7352 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007353 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
7354 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
7355 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
7356 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
7357 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
7358 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007359
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007360 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
7361 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
7362 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
7363 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007364
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007365 Five types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007366 - accept :
7367 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7368 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7369 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007370
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007371 - reject :
7372 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7373 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7374 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
7375 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
7376 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
7377 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
7378 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
7379 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
7380 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
7381 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
7382 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
7383 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007384
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007385 - expect-proxy layer4 :
7386 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
7387 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
7388 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
7389 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
7390 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
7391 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
7392 hosts.
7393
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007394 - capture <sample> len <length> :
7395 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
7396 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
7397 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
7398 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
7399 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
7400 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
7401 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
7402 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
7403 session life. Since it applies to Please check section 7.3 (Fetching
7404 samples) and "capture request header" for more information.
7405
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007406 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007407 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
7408 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
7409 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007410 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
7411 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007412 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007413 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
7414 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
7415 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
7416 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
7417 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007418
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007419 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007420 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02007421 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007422 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
7423 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
7424 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
7425 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007426
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007427 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
7428 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
7429 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
7430 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007431
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007432 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
7433 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
7434 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
7435 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
7436 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007437 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
7438 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
7439 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
7440 layer7 information is extracted.
7441
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007442 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
7443 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
7444 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
7445 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
7446 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007447
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007448 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7449 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7450 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007451
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007452 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
7453 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
7454 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007455
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007456 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007457 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007458 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007459
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007460 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
7461 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
7462 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007463
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007464 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007465 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7466 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007467
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007468 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
7469
7470 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
7471
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007472 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7473
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007474 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007475
7476
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007477tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7478 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007479 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007480 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007481 Arguments :
7482 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007483 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007484 "track-sc2" and "capture". See "tcp-request connection" above
7485 for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007486
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007487 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007488
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007489 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
7490 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7491 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
7492 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
7493 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007494
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007495 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
7496 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
7497 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
7498 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007499 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
7500 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
7501 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
7502 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
7503 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
7504 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007505 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007506 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007507
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007508 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7509 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7510 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7511 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007512
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007513 Four types of actions are supported :
7514 - accept : the request is accepted
7515 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
7516 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007517 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007518
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007519 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
7520 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007521
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007522 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
7523 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
7524 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
7525 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
7526 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
7527 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007528
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007529 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007530 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7531 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007532
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007533 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007534 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
7535 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
7536 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
7537 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007538 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
7539 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
7540 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007541
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007542 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
7543 are present when the rule is processed. The current solution for making the
7544 rule engine wait for such information is to set an inspect delay and to
7545 condition its execution with an ACL relying on such information.
7546
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007547 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007548 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
7549 # and reject everything else.
7550 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
7551 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007552 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007553 tcp-request content reject
7554
7555 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007556 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
7557 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7558 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007559 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007560
7561 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
7562 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7563 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007564 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007565 tcp-request content reject
7566
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007567 Example:
7568 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
7569 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007570 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1) if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007571
7572 Example:
7573 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
7574 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007575 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007576
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007577 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
7578 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
7579
7580 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007581 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007582 # protecting all our sites
7583 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007584 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7585 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007586 ...
7587 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
7588
7589 backend http_dynamic
7590 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007591 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007592 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007593 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7594 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
7595 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007596 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007597
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007598 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007599
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007600 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007601
7602
7603tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
7604 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
7605 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007606 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007607 Arguments :
7608 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7609 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7610 as explained at the top of this document.
7611
7612 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
7613 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
7614 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
7615 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
7616 data for at most the specified amount of time.
7617
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007618 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
7619 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
7620 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
7621 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
7622
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007623 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
7624 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007625 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007626 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01007627 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
7628 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
7629 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
7630 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007631
7632 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
7633 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
7634 it pass through unaffected.
7635
7636 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
7637 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
7638 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007639 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007640 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
7641 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02007642 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
7643 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
7644 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007645
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007646 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007647 "timeout client".
7648
7649
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007650tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7651 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
7652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7653 no | no | yes | yes
7654 Arguments :
7655 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007656 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007657
7658 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
7659
7660 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
7661 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7662 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007663 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
7664 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007665
7666 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
7667
7668 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7669 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7670 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7671 inserted.
7672
7673 Two types of actions are supported :
7674 - accept :
7675 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7676 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7677 the rules evaluation.
7678
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007679 - close :
7680 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
7681 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
7682 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
7683 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
7684 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
7685 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007686 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007687 protocols.
7688
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007689 - reject :
7690 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7691 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007692 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007693
7694 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7695 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7696 for changing the default action to a reject.
7697
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007698 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
7699 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
7700 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
7701 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007702 period.
7703
7704 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7705
7706 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
7707
7708
7709tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
7710 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
7711 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7712 no | no | yes | yes
7713 Arguments :
7714 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7715 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7716 as explained at the top of this document.
7717
7718 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
7719
7720
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007721timeout check <timeout>
7722 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
7723 established.
7724
7725 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7726 yes | no | yes | yes
7727 Arguments:
7728 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7729 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7730 as explained at the top of this document.
7731
7732 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
7733 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
7734 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
7735 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01007736 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
7737 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
7738 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007739
7740 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
7741 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
7742
7743 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
7744 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007745 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007746
7747 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7748 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7749 forget about it.
7750
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007751 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
7752 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007753
7754
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007755timeout client <timeout>
7756timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7757 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
7758 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7759 yes | yes | yes | no
7760 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007761 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007762 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7763 as explained at the top of this document.
7764
7765 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7766 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7767 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
7768 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
7769 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
7770 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
7771 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
7772 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007773 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007774 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007775 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
7776 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007777 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
7778 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007779
7780 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7781 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7782 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7783 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7784 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7785 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7786
7787 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
7788 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
7789 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7790
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007791 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007792
7793
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007794timeout client-fin <timeout>
7795 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
7796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7797 yes | yes | yes | no
7798 Arguments :
7799 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7800 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7801 as explained at the top of this document.
7802
7803 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7804 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
7805 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
7806 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
7807 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
7808 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
7809 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
7810 down in one direction.
7811
7812 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7813 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
7814 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
7815
7816 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
7817
7818
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007819timeout connect <timeout>
7820timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7821 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
7822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7823 yes | no | yes | yes
7824 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007825 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007826 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7827 as explained at the top of this document.
7828
7829 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007830 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007831 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007832 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007833 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
7834 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007835
7836 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7837 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7838 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7839 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7840 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
7841 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7842
7843 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
7844 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
7845 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7846
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007847 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
7848 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007849
7850
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007851timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
7852 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
7853 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7854 yes | yes | yes | yes
7855 Arguments :
7856 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7857 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7858 as explained at the top of this document.
7859
7860 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
7861 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
7862 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
7863 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
7864 once the request has started to present itself.
7865
7866 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
7867 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
7868 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
7869 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
7870 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
7871
7872 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
7873 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
7874 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
7875 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
7876
7877 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
7878 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
7879 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
7880 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
7881 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007882 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007883
7884 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
7885 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
7886 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
7887 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
7888
7889 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
7890
7891
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007892timeout http-request <timeout>
7893 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
7894 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007895 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007896 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007897 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007898 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7899 as explained at the top of this document.
7900
7901 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
7902 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
7903 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
7904 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
7905 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
7906 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
7907 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02007908 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
7909 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
7910 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
7911 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
7912 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
7913 code using "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See more details in the explanations of
7914 the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007915
7916 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
7917 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007918 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
7919 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007920
7921 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
7922 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
7923 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
7924 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
7925 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
7926
7927 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007928 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
7929 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
7930 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007931
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02007932 See also : "errorfile", "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007933
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007934
7935timeout queue <timeout>
7936 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
7937 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7938 yes | no | yes | yes
7939 Arguments :
7940 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7941 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7942 as explained at the top of this document.
7943
7944 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
7945 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
7946 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
7947 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
7948 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
7949
7950 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
7951 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
7952 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
7953 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
7954
7955 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7956
7957
7958timeout server <timeout>
7959timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7960 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7961 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7962 yes | no | yes | yes
7963 Arguments :
7964 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7965 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7966 as explained at the top of this document.
7967
7968 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7969 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7970 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7971 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7972 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7973 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7974 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7975
7976 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7977 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7978 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7979 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7980 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007981 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007982 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007983 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
7984 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
7985 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
7986 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007987
7988 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7989 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7990 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7991 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7992 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7993 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7994
7995 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
7996 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
7997 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7998
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007999 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008000
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008001
8002timeout server-fin <timeout>
8003 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
8004 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8005 yes | no | yes | yes
8006 Arguments :
8007 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8008 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8009 as explained at the top of this document.
8010
8011 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8012 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8013 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8014 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8015 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
8016 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8017 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8018 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
8019 situations, it should not be needed.
8020
8021 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8022 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8023 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
8024
8025 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
8026
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008027
8028timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008029 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008030 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8031 yes | yes | yes | yes
8032 Arguments :
8033 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
8034 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8035 as explained at the top of this document.
8036
8037 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
8038 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
8039 defines how long it will be maintained open.
8040
8041 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8042 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8043 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
8044 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008045 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008046
8047 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8048
8049
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008050timeout tunnel <timeout>
8051 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
8052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8053 yes | no | yes | yes
8054 Arguments :
8055 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8056 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8057 as explained at the top of this document.
8058
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008059 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008060 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
8061 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
8062 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
8063 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
8064 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
8065 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
8066 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
8067 specified.
8068
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008069 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
8070 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
8071 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
8072 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
8073 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
8074 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
8075 state.
8076
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008077 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8078 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8079 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
8080 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
8081 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
8082
8083 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8084 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8085 forget about it.
8086
8087 Example :
8088 defaults http
8089 option http-server-close
8090 timeout connect 5s
8091 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008092 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008093 timeout server 30s
8094 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
8095
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008096 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008097
8098
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008099transparent (deprecated)
8100 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8101 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008102 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008103 Arguments : none
8104
8105 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
8106 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8107 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8108 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8109 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8110 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8111 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8112 appropriate server.
8113
8114 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
8115
8116 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8117 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8118
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008119 See also: "option transparent"
8120
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008121unique-id-format <string>
8122 Generate a unique ID for each request.
8123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8124 yes | yes | yes | no
8125 Arguments :
8126 <string> is a log-format string.
8127
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008128 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
8129 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
8130 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
8131 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008132
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008133 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
8134 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
8135 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
8136 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
8137 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
8138 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
8139 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
8140 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008141
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008142 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
8143 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008144
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008145 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008146
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008147 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008148
8149 will generate:
8150
8151 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8152
8153 See also: "unique-id-header"
8154
8155unique-id-header <name>
8156 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
8157 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8158 yes | yes | yes | no
8159 Arguments :
8160 <name> is the name of the header.
8161
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008162 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
8163 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008164
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008165 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008166
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008167 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008168 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
8169
8170 will generate:
8171
8172 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8173
8174 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008175
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008176use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008177 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008178 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8179 no | yes | yes | no
8180 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008181 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
8182 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008183
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008184 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
8185 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008186
8187 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
8188 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
8189 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008190 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
8191 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
8192 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
8193 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008194
8195 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
8196 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
8197 assign the backend.
8198
8199 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
8200 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8201 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
8202 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
8203 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
8204 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
8205
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008206 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008207 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008208 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
8209 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
8210 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
8211
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008212 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
8213 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
8214 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
8215 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
8216 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
8217 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
8218 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
8219 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
8220 cannot be forced from the request.
8221
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008222 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008223 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
8224 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
8225
8226 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
8227 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008228
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008229
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008230use-server <server> if <condition>
8231use-server <server> unless <condition>
8232 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
8233 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8234 no | no | yes | yes
8235 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008236 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008237
8238 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
8239
8240 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
8241 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
8242 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
8243
8244 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
8245 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
8246 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
8247 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
8248 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
8249 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
8250 matches will assign the server.
8251
8252 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
8253 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
8254 with the next rules until one matches.
8255
8256 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
8257 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8258 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
8259 according to other persistence mechanisms.
8260
8261 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
8262 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
8263 stripped.
8264
8265 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
8266 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
8267 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
8268 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
8269
8270 Example :
8271 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
8272 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
8273 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
8274 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
8275 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
8276 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
8277 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
8278 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
8279 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
8280
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008281 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008282
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008283
82845. Bind and Server options
8285--------------------------
8286
8287The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
8288depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
8289settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
8290written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
8291described in this section.
8292
8293
82945.1. Bind options
8295-----------------
8296
8297The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
8298as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
8299no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
8300parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
8301while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
8302provided immediately after the setting name.
8303
8304The currently supported settings are the following ones.
8305
8306accept-proxy
8307 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02008308 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
8309 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008310 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
8311 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
8312 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
8313 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
8314 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
8315 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
8316 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008317 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
8318 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008319
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008320alpn <protocols>
8321 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
8322 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
8323 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
8324 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
8325 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
8326 initial NPN extension.
8327
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008328backlog <backlog>
8329 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
8330 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
8331
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008332ecdhe <named curve>
8333 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01008334 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
8335 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008336
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008337ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008338 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8339 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8340 client's certificate.
8341
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008342ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
8343 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8344 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
8345 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
8346 error is ignored.
8347
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008348ciphers <ciphers>
8349 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
8350 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008351 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008352 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
8353 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
8354
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008355crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008356 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8357 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8358 to verify client's certificate.
8359
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008360crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008361 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8362 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
8363 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
8364 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
8365 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
8366 file.
8367
8368 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
8369 are loaded.
8370
8371 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02008372 that directory will be loaded unless their name ends with '.issuer' or
8373 '.ocsp' (reserved extensions). This directive may be specified multiple times
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008374 in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
8375 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
8376 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
8377 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
8378 hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
8379 www.sub.example.org).
8380
8381 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
8382 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
8383 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
8384 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
8385 recommended to load the default one first as a file.
8386
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02008387 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008388
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008389 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
8390 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08008391 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008392 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
8393 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
8394 clients).
8395
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02008396 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
8397 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
8398 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
8399 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
8400 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
8401 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
8402 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
8403 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
8404 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
8405 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
8406 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
8407 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
8408 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
8409
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008410crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008411 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
8412 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008413 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008414 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008415
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008416crt-list <file>
8417 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008418 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
8419 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008420
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008421 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008422
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008423 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
8424 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
8425 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
8426 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
8427 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
8428 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
8429 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
8430 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008431
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008432defer-accept
8433 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8434 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
8435 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
8436 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
8437 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
8438 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
8439 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
8440 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
8441 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
8442 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
8443 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
8444
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008445force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008446 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008447 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
8448 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8449
8450force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008451 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008452 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8453
8454force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008455 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008456 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8457
8458force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008459 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008460 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8461
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008462gid <gid>
8463 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
8464 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8465 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
8466 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
8467 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8468
8469group <group>
8470 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
8471 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
8472 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
8473 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
8474 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8475
8476id <id>
8477 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
8478 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
8479 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
8480 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
8481
8482interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01008483 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
8484 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
8485 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
8486 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
8487 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
8488 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
8489 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008490
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02008491level <level>
8492 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
8493 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
8494 sockets. <level> can be one of :
8495 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
8496 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
8497 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
8498 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
8499 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
8500 counters).
8501 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
8502 all counters).
8503
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008504maxconn <maxconn>
8505 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
8506 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
8507 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
8508 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
8509 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
8510 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
8511 eat all memory.
8512
8513mode <mode>
8514 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
8515 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
8516 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
8517 UNIX sockets.
8518
8519mss <maxseg>
8520 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
8521 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
8522 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
8523 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
8524 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
8525 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
8526 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
8527 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
8528 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
8529 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
8530 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
8531
8532name <name>
8533 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
8534 page.
8535
8536nice <nice>
8537 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
8538 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
8539 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
8540 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
8541 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
8542 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
8543 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
8544 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
8545 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
8546 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
8547 one for an RDP socket.
8548
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008549no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008550 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008551 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008552 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008553 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8554 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008555
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008556no-tls-tickets
8557 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8558 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8559 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
8560 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
8561
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008562no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008563 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008564 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008565 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8566 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8567 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008568
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008569no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008570 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008571 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008572 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8573 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8574 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008575
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008576no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008577 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008578 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008579 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8580 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8581 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008582
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008583npn <protocols>
8584 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
8585 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
8586 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
8587 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008588 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
8589 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008590
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008591process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
8592 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
8593 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
8594 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
8595 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
8596 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
8597 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
8598 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02008599 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
8600 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
8601 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
8602 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
8603 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
8604 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
8605 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008606
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008607ssl
8608 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008609 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008610 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
8611 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
8612 to deciphered contents.
8613
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01008614strict-sni
8615 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
8616 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
8617 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
8618 See the "crt" option for more information.
8619
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008620tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01008621 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008622 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
8623 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
8624 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
8625 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
8626 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
8627 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
8628 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02008629 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
8630 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
8631 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008632
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008633transparent
8634 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8635 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
8636 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
8637 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
8638 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
8639 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
8640 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
8641 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
8642 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
8643 so check for support with your vendor.
8644
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008645v4v6
8646 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8647 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
8648 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
8649 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008650 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008651
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008652v6only
8653 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8654 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
8655 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008656 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
8657 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008658
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008659uid <uid>
8660 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
8661 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8662 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
8663 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
8664 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8665
8666user <user>
8667 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
8668 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8669 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
8670 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
8671 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8672
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008673verify [none|optional|required]
8674 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8675 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
8676 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
8677 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
8678 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008679 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
8680 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
8681 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
8682 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008683
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020086845.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008685------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008686
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008687The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
8688which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
8689arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
8690settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
8691after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
8692Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
8693address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008694
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008695 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008696 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008697
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008698The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008699
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008700addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008701 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
8702 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
8703 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
8704 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
8705 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008706
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008707 Supported in default-server: No
8708
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008709agent-check
8710 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008711 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
8712 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
8713 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
8714 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008715
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008716 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008717 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
8718 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts.
8719
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008720 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8721 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008722
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008723 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8724 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
8725 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008726
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008727 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8728 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
8729 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008730
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008731 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
8732 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
8733 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
8734 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
8735 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
8736 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
8737 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008738
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008739 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
8740 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008741
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008742 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
8743 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
8744 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
8745 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
8746 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
8747 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
8748 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
8749 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
8750 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008751
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008752 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
8753 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008754 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
8755 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
8756 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
8757 force an agent's result in order to workaround a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008758
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008759 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
8760 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008761
8762 Supported in default-server: No
8763
8764agent-inter <delay>
8765 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
8766 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8767
8768 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
8769 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
8770 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
8771 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
8772 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8773 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8774 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8775 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8776 of backends use the same servers.
8777
8778 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
8779
8780 Supported in default-server: Yes
8781
8782agent-port <port>
8783 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
8784
8785 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
8786
8787 Supported in default-server: Yes
8788
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008789backup
8790 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
8791 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
8792 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
8793 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
8794 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
8795 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008796
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008797 Supported in default-server: No
8798
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008799ca-file <cafile>
8800 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8801 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8802 server's certificate.
8803
8804 Supported in default-server: No
8805
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008806check
8807 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01008808 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
8809 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
8810 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
8811 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
8812 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
8813 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
8814 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008815 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
8816 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
8817 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008818
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008819 Supported in default-server: No
8820
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008821check-send-proxy
8822 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
8823 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
8824 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
8825 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
8826 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
8827 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
8828 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
8829
8830 Supported in default-server: No
8831
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008832check-ssl
8833 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
8834 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
8835 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
8836 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008837 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008838 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
8839 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
8840 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
8841 See the "ssl" option for more information.
8842
8843 Supported in default-server: No
8844
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008845ciphers <ciphers>
8846 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008847 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008848 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
8849 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
8850 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
8851 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
8852 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
8853 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
8854
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008855 Supported in default-server: No
8856
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008857cookie <value>
8858 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
8859 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
8860 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
8861 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
8862 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
8863 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
8864 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
8865
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008866 Supported in default-server: No
8867
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008868crl-file <crlfile>
8869 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8870 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8871 to verify server's certificate.
8872
8873 Supported in default-server: No
8874
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02008875crt <cert>
8876 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8877 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
8878 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
8879 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
8880 certificate request.
8881
8882 Supported in default-server: No
8883
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02008884disabled
8885 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
8886 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
8887 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
8888 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
8889 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
8890
8891 Supported in default-server: No
8892
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008893error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008894 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
8895 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
8896 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008897
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008898 Supported in default-server: Yes
8899
8900 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008901
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008902fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008903 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
8904 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
8905 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
8906
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008907 Supported in default-server: Yes
8908
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008909force-sslv3
8910 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8911 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
8912 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8913
8914 Supported in default-server: No
8915
8916force-tlsv10
8917 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8918 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8919
8920 Supported in default-server: No
8921
8922force-tlsv11
8923 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8924 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8925
8926 Supported in default-server: No
8927
8928force-tlsv12
8929 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8930 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8931
8932 Supported in default-server: No
8933
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008934id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008935 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
8936 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
8937 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008938
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008939 Supported in default-server: No
8940
8941inter <delay>
8942fastinter <delay>
8943downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008944 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
8945 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8946 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
8947 between checks depending on the server state :
8948
8949 Server state | Interval used
8950 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8951 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
8952 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8953 Transitionally UP (going down), |
8954 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8955 or yet unchecked. |
8956 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8957 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8958 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008959
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008960 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
8961 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
8962 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
8963 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008964 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8965 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8966 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8967 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8968 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008969
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008970 Supported in default-server: Yes
8971
8972maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008973 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
8974 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
8975 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
8976 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
8977 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
8978 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
8979 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
8980 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
8981
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008982 Supported in default-server: Yes
8983
8984maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008985 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
8986 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
8987 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
8988 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
8989 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
8990 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
8991 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
8992
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008993 Supported in default-server: Yes
8994
8995minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008996 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
8997 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
8998 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
8999 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
9000 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
9001 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009002 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009003 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009004
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009005 Supported in default-server: Yes
9006
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009007no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009008 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
9009 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009010 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009011
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009012 Supported in default-server: No
9013
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009014no-tls-tickets
9015 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9016 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9017 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
9018 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
9019
9020 Supported in default-server: No
9021
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009022no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009023 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009024 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9025 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009026 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
9027 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009028
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009029 Supported in default-server: No
9030
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009031no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009032 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009033 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9034 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009035 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
9036 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009037
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009038 Supported in default-server: No
9039
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009040no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009041 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009042 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9043 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009044 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
9045 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009046
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009047 Supported in default-server: No
9048
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09009049non-stick
9050 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
9051 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
9052 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
9053
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009054 Supported in default-server: No
9055
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009056observe <mode>
9057 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
9058 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
9059 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
9060 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
9061 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
9062 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01009063 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009064
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009065 Supported in default-server: No
9066
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009067 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
9068
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009069on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009070 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
9071 Currently, four modes are available:
9072 - fastinter: force fastinter
9073 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
9074 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
9075 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
9076 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
9077
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009078 Supported in default-server: Yes
9079
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009080 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
9081
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009082on-marked-down <action>
9083 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
9084 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009085 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
9086 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
9087 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
9088 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
9089 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
9090 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
9091 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
9092 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009093
9094 Actions are disabled by default
9095
9096 Supported in default-server: Yes
9097
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009098on-marked-up <action>
9099 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
9100 Currently one action is available:
9101 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
9102 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
9103 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
9104 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
9105 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
9106 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
9107 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
9108 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
9109
9110 Actions are disabled by default
9111
9112 Supported in default-server: Yes
9113
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009114port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009115 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
9116 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
9117 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
9118 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
9119 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
9120 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
9121
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009122 Supported in default-server: Yes
9123
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009124redir <prefix>
9125 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
9126 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
9127 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
9128 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
9129 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
9130 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
9131 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
9132 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009133 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009134 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
9135 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
9136 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
9137 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
9138 loop between the client and HAProxy!
9139
9140 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
9141
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009142 Supported in default-server: No
9143
9144rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009145 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
9146 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
9147 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
9148
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009149 Supported in default-server: Yes
9150
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009151send-proxy
9152 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
9153 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
9154 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
9155 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
9156 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
9157 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
9158 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
9159 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
9160 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009161 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
9162 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
9163 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
9164 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
9165 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009166
9167 Supported in default-server: No
9168
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -04009169send-proxy-v2
9170 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
9171 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9172 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9173 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9174 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
9175 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
9176 option of the "bind" keyword.
9177
9178 Supported in default-server: No
9179
9180send-proxy-v2-ssl
9181 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9182 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9183 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9184 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9185 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9186 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
9187 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
9188 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9189
9190 Supported in default-server: No
9191
9192send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
9193 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9194 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9195 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9196 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9197 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9198 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
9199 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
9200 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
9201 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9202
9203 Supported in default-server: No
9204
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009205slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009206 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
9207 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
9208 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
9209 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
9210 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
9211 parameters :
9212
9213 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
9214 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
9215
9216 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
9217 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
9218 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
9219 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
9220
9221 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
9222 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
9223 seen as failed.
9224
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009225 Supported in default-server: Yes
9226
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009227source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009228source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009229source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009230 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
9231 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
9232 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
9233 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
9234
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009235 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
9236 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
9237 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
9238 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
9239 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
9240 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
9241 server.
9242
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009243 Supported in default-server: No
9244
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009245ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009246 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
9247 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
9248 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
9249 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
9250 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
9251 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009252 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009253
9254 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009255
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009256track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +02009257 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
9258 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
9259 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
9260 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009261 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
9262
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009263 Supported in default-server: No
9264
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009265verify [none|required]
9266 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01009267 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
9268 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
9269 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
9270 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009271 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
9272 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
9273 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009274
9275 Supported in default-server: No
9276
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07009277verifyhost <hostname>
9278 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
9279 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
9280 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
9281 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
9282 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
9283 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
9284
9285 Supported in default-server: No
9286
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009287weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009288 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
9289 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
9290 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02009291 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
9292 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
9293 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
9294 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
9295 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
9296 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009297
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009298 Supported in default-server: Yes
9299
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009300
93016. HTTP header manipulation
9302---------------------------
9303
9304In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
9305response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
9306request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
9307which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009308against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009309
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009310If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
9311to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
9312but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
9313HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
9314stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
9315because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
9316a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
9317still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02009318
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009319This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
9320in section 4.2 :
9321
9322 - reqadd <string>
9323 - reqallow <search>
9324 - reqiallow <search>
9325 - reqdel <search>
9326 - reqidel <search>
9327 - reqdeny <search>
9328 - reqideny <search>
9329 - reqpass <search>
9330 - reqipass <search>
9331 - reqrep <search> <replace>
9332 - reqirep <search> <replace>
9333 - reqtarpit <search>
9334 - reqitarpit <search>
9335 - rspadd <string>
9336 - rspdel <search>
9337 - rspidel <search>
9338 - rspdeny <search>
9339 - rspideny <search>
9340 - rsprep <search> <replace>
9341 - rspirep <search> <replace>
9342
9343With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
9344is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
9345parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
9346prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
9347Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
9348
9349 \t for a tab
9350 \r for a carriage return (CR)
9351 \n for a new line (LF)
9352 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
9353 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
9354 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
9355 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
9356 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
9357
9358The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
9359portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
9360above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
9361regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
93629 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
9363is very common to users of the "sed" program.
9364
9365The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
9366after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
9367
9368Notes related to these keywords :
9369---------------------------------
9370 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
9371 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
9372 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
9373
9374 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
9375 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
9376 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
9377
9378 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
9379 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
9380 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
9381 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
9382 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
9383
9384 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
9385 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
9386 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
9387 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
9388 useless headers before adding new ones.
9389
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009390 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009391 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
9392
9393 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
9394 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
9395 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
9396
9397 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
9398 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009399 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009400
9401
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020094027. Using ACLs and fetching samples
9403----------------------------------
9404
9405Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
9406client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
9407The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
9408these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
9409but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
9410data called patterns.
9411
9412
94137.1. ACL basics
9414---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009415
9416The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
9417content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
9418from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
9419simple :
9420
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009421 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009422 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009423 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
9424 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009426The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
9427adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009428
9429In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
9430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009431 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009432
9433This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
9434Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
9435and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009436an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
9437conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
9438as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
9439are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009440
9441ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
9442'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
9443which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
9444
9445There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
9446performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
9447
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009448The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
9449specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
9450this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009451methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
9452ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009453
9454Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
9455 - boolean
9456 - integer (signed or unsigned)
9457 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
9458 - string
9459 - data block
9460
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009461Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
9462converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
9463would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
9464The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
9465which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
9466
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009467Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
9468keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
9469fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
9470which are summarized in the table below :
9471
9472 +---------------------+-----------------+
9473 | Sample or converter | Default |
9474 | output type | matching method |
9475 +---------------------+-----------------+
9476 | boolean | bool |
9477 +---------------------+-----------------+
9478 | integer | int |
9479 +---------------------+-----------------+
9480 | ip | ip |
9481 +---------------------+-----------------+
9482 | string | str |
9483 +---------------------+-----------------+
9484 | binary | none, use "-m" |
9485 +---------------------+-----------------+
9486
9487Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
9488matching method, see below.
9489
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009490The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
9491 - boolean
9492 - integer or integer range
9493 - IP address / network
9494 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
9495 - regular expression
9496 - hex block
9497
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009498The following ACL flags are currently supported :
9499
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009500 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
9501 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009502 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009503 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009504 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009505 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009506 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
9507
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009508The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
9509read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
9510if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
9511lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
9512will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
9513beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
9514a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
9515lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
9516exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
9517
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009518The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
9519parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
9520ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
9521a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
9522check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
9523
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009524The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
9525socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
9526file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
9527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009528Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
9529loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
9530
9531 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
9532
9533In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
9534the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
9535case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
9536as well.
9537
9538The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
9539sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
9540do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
9541methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
9542is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
9543obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
9544followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
9545default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
9546that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
9547string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
9548
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009549The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
9550By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
9551string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
9552resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
9553server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
9554waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
9555flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
9556function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
9557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009558There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
9559sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
9560be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009561
9562 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
9563 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009564 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
9565 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
9566 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
9567 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009568
9569 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
9570 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009571 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009572
9573 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009574 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009575
9576 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009577 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009578
9579 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
9580 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
9581
9582 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
9583 binary or string samples.
9584
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009585 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
9586 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009588 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
9589 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
9590 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009592 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
9593 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009595 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
9596 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009598 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
9599 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009600
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009601 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
9602 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009603 This may be used with binary or string samples.
9604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009605 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
9606 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
9607 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009608
9609For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
9610request, it is possible to do :
9611
9612 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
9613
9614In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
9615buffer, one would use the following acl :
9616
9617 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
9618
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009619On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
9620possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
9621
9622 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
9623
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009624All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
9625criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
9626method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
9627to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
9628criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
9629the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009631If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009632the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
9633For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009635 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
9636 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
9637 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
9638 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009639
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009640
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009641The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
9642types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
9643combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
9644brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
9645default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009647 +-------------------------------------------------+
9648 | Input sample type |
9649 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009650 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009651 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9652 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
9653 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009654 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009655 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009656 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009657 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009658 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009659 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009660 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009661 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009662 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009663 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009664 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009665 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009666 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009667 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009668 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009669 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009670 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009671 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009672 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009673 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009674 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009675 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9676 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
9677 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009678
9679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020096807.1.1. Matching booleans
9681------------------------
9682
9683In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
9684Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
9685When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
9686that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
9687
9688Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
9689return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
9690"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
9691
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020096937.1.2. Matching integers
9694------------------------
9695
9696Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
9697enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
9698to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
9699
9700Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
9701matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
9702lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009703
9704For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
9705unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
9706representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
9707
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009708As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
9709two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
9710instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
9711ranges and operators.
9712
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009713For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009714operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
9715Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
9716of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009717
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009718Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009719
9720 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
9721 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
9722 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
9723 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
9724 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
9725
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009726For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009727
9728 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
9729
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009730This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
9731
9732 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
9733
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009734
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097357.1.3. Matching strings
9736-----------------------
9737
9738String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
9739different forms :
9740
9741 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
9742 patterns ;
9743
9744 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
9745 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
9746
9747 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
9748 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9749
9750 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
9751 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9752
9753 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9754 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
9755 matches.
9756
9757 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9758 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
9759 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009760
9761String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
9762exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
9763characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
9764string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
9765to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009766before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009767
9768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097697.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
9770---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009771
9772Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
9773they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
9774possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
9775passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
9776the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009777the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
9778match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009779
9780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097817.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
9782-------------------------------------
9783
9784It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
9785not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
9786a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
9787to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
9788digits may be used upper or lower case.
9789
9790Example :
9791 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
9792 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
9793
9794
97957.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
9796---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009797
9798IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
9799netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
9800within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009801host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009802difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
9803at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
9804does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
9805parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009806
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009807IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
9808Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
9809trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
9810IPv6 patterns.
9811
9812HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
9813following situations :
9814 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
9815 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
9816 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
9817 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
9818 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
9819 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
9820 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
9821 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
9822 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
9823 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
9824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009825
98267.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
9827----------------------------------
9828
9829Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9830combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
9831
9832 - AND (implicit)
9833 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9834 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009835
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009836A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009838 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009840Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9841indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009843For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9844"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9845requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9846is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
9847
9848 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9849 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9850 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9851 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
9852
9853To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9854and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
9855
9856 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9857 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9858 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9859 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
9860
9861 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9862 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9863 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9864 use_backend www if host_www
9865
9866It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9867expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9868be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
9869the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
9870
9871 The following rule :
9872
9873 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9874 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9875
9876 Can also be written that way :
9877
9878 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9879
9880It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9881to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9882simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9883sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9884good use is the following :
9885
9886 With named ACLs :
9887
9888 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9889 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9890 monitor fail if site_dead
9891
9892 With anonymous ACLs :
9893
9894 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9895
9896See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
9897
9898
98997.3. Fetching samples
9900---------------------
9901
9902Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
9903against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
9904sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
9905ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
9906of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
9907available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
9908
9909This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
9910Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
9911compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
9912deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
9913
9914The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
9915matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
9916method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
9917indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
9918
9919As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
9920when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
9921mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
9922the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
9923ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
9924
9925Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
9926multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
9927when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
9928incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
9929are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
9930is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
9931all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
9932
9933Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
9934 - name
9935 - name(arg1)
9936 - name(arg1,arg2)
9937
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009938
99397.3.1. Converters
9940-----------------
9941
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009942Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
9943of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
9944is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
9945was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
9946has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
9947unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
9948
9949These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
9950sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
9951the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
9952support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009953
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009954The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009955
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +02009956base64
9957 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
9958 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
9959 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
9960
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009961lower
9962 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
9963 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
9964 type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009965
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009966upper
9967 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
9968 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
9969 type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009970
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009971hex
9972 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
9973 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
9974 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
9975 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +01009976
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009977ipmask(<mask>)
9978 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
9979 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
9980 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
9981 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009982
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009983http_date([<offset>])
9984 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
9985 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
9986 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
9987 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
9988 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
9989 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009990
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009991language(<value>[,<default>])
9992 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
9993 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
9994 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
9995 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
9996 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
9997 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
9998 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
9999 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
10000 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
10001 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
10002 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
10003 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010004
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010005 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010006
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010007 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
10008 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010009
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010010 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
10011 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
10012 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
10013 use_backend spanish if es
10014 use_backend french if fr
10015 use_backend english if en
10016 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010017
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010018map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10019map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10020map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10021 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
10022 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
10023 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
10024 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
10025 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
10026 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
10027 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
10028 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010029
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010030 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
10031 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
10032 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010033
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010034 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
10035 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010036
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010037 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
10038 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10039 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
10040 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020010041 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
10042 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010043 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
10044 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10045 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
10046 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10047 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
10048 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10049 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
10050 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10051 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
10052 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10053 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
10054 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10055 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
10056 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010057
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010058 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
10059 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
10060 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
10061 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
10062 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010063
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010064 Example :
10065
10066 # this is a comment and is ignored
10067 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
10068 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
10069 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
10070 | | | `---------- value
10071 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
10072 | `---------------------------- key
10073 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
10074
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010075
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200100767.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010077--------------------------------------------
10078
10079A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
10080not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
10081"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
10082The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
10083
10084always_false : boolean
10085 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10086 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10087
10088always_true : boolean
10089 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10090 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10091
10092avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010093 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010094 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
10095 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
10096 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
10097 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
10098 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
10099 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
10100 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
10101 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
10102 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
10103 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
10104 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
10105 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
10106 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010010107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010108be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010109 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
10110 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
10111 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
10112 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
10113 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010115be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
10116 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10117 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10118 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
10119 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
10120 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
10121 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010122
10123 Example :
10124 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
10125 backend dynamic
10126 mode http
10127 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
10128 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010130connslots([<backend>]) : integer
10131 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010132 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010133 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
10134 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050010135
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010136 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010137 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010138 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
10139
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010140 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
10141 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010142
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010143 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010144 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010145 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010146 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
10147 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010148 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010149 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010150
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010151 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
10152 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010153 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010154 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010155
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010156date([<offset>]) : integer
10157 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
10158 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
10159 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
10160 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020010161 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
10162
10163 Example :
10164
10165 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
10166 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010167
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020010168env(<name>) : string
10169 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
10170 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
10171 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
10172 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
10173 certain way.
10174
10175 Examples :
10176 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
10177 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
10178
10179 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
10180 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
10181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010182fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
10183 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010184 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
10185 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010186 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
10187 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
10188 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
10189 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
10190 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010191
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010192fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
10193 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10194 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10195 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
10196 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
10197 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
10198 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
10199 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
10200 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010201
10202 Example :
10203 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
10204 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
10205 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
10206 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
10207 frontend mail
10208 bind :25
10209 mode tcp
10210 maxconn 100
10211 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
10212 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
10213 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
10214 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010216nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
10217 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
10218 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
10219 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010220 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
10221 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
10222 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010224queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010225 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
10226 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
10227 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010228 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
10229 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
10230 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
10231 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
10232 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
10233
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010010234rand([<range>]) : integer
10235 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
10236 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
10237 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
10238 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
10239 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
10240
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010241srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10242 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10243 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
10244 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
10245 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
10246 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
10247 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
10248 methods.
10249
10250srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
10251 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
10252 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
10253 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
10254 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
10255 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
10256 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
10257 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
10258
10259srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10260 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10261 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010262 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010263 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
10264 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
10265 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
10266 overloading servers).
10267
10268 Example :
10269 # Redirect to a separate back
10270 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
10271 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
10272 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
10273
10274table_avl([<table>]) : integer
10275 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
10276 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
10277
10278table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10279 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
10280 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
10281 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
10282
10283
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200102847.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010285----------------------------------
10286
10287The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
10288closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
10289methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
10290sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
10291TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010292the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
10293counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
10294"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010295argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
10296the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
10297this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010298
10299be_id : integer
10300 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
10301 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
10302
10303dst : ip
10304 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
10305 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
10306 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
10307 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
10308 RFC 4291.
10309
10310dst_conn : integer
10311 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10312 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
10313 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
10314 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
10315 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
10316 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
10317 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
10318 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010319
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010320dst_port : integer
10321 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
10322 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
10323 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
10324 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
10325 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
10326 an HTTP header.
10327
10328fe_id : integer
10329 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
10330 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
10331 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
10332
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010333sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010334sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10335sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10336sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010337 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
10338 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10339 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
10340
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010341sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010342sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10343sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10344sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010345 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
10346 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10347 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
10348
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010349sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010350sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10351sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10352sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010353 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
10354 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010355 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
10356 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
10357 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010358
10359 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10360 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010361 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10362 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
10363 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010364 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10365 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10366
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010367sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010368sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10369sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10370sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010371 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
10372 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
10373
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010374sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010375sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10376sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10377sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010378 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10379 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
10380 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
10381
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010382sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010383sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10384sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10385sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010386 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
10387 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
10388 See also src_conn_rate.
10389
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010390sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010391sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10392sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10393sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010394 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010395 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010396
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010397sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010398sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10399sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10400sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010401 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10402 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
10403 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010404 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10405 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10406 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010407
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010408sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010409sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10410sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10411sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010412 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
10413 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
10414 See also src_http_err_cnt.
10415
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010416sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010417sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10418sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10419sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010420 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
10421 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10422 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
10423 src_http_err_rate.
10424
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010425sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010426sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10427sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10428sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010429 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10430 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10431 src_http_req_cnt.
10432
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010433sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010434sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10435sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10436sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010437 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10438 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
10439 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10440 src_http_req_rate.
10441
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010442sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010443sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10444sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10445sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010446 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010447 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
10448 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
10449 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
10450 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010451
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010452 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10453 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010454 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10455
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010456sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010457sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10458sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10459sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010460 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
10461 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
10462 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
10463 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
10464
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010465sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010466sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10467sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10468sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010469 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
10470 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
10471 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
10472 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
10473
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010474sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010475sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10476sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10477sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010478 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
10479 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
10480 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
10481 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010482 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010483 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
10484
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010485sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010486sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10487sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10488sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010489 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
10490 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10491 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
10492 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
10493 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010494 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010495
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010496sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010497sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10498sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10499sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020010500 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
10501 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
10502 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
10503
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010504sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010505sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10506sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10507sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010508 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10509 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010510 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010511 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
10512 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010513 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
10514 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
10515 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010517so_id : integer
10518 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
10519 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
10520 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010521
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010522src : ip
10523 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
10524 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
10525 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
10526 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
10527 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
10528 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
10529 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010530
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010531 Example:
10532 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
10533 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
10534
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010535src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10536 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
10537 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
10538 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010539 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010540
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010541src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10542 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
10543 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010544 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010545 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010547src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10548 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10549 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10550 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
10551 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
10552 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
10553 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010554
10555 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10556 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
10557 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
10558 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010559 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010560 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10561 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010563src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010564 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010565 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010566 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010567 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010569src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010570 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010571 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
10572 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010573 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010575src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10576 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
10577 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10578 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010579 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010581src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010582 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010583 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010584 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010585 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010587src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010588 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010589 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010590 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
10591 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010592 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10593 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10594 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010595
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010596src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10597 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
10598 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010599 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010600 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010601 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010603src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10604 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
10605 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10606 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10607 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010608 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010609
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010610src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10611 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10612 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10613 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010614 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010616src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10617 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10618 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10619 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010620 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010621 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010623src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10624 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10625 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10626 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010627 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010628 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
10629 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010630
10631 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010632 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010633 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010635src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10636 Returns the amount of data received from the incoming connection's source
10637 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10638 measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address
10639 is not found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010640 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also
10641 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010642
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010643src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10644 Returns the amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source address
10645 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010646 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
10647 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010648 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010650src_port : integer
10651 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
10652 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
10653 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
10654 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010655
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010656src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10657 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010658 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10659 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
10660 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010661 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010662
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010663src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10664 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
10665 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10666 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10667 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010668 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010670src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10671 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
10672 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
10673 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
10674 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
10675 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
10676 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
10677 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
10678 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010679
10680 Example :
10681 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
10682 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
10683 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
10684 listen ssh
10685 bind :22
10686 mode tcp
10687 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010688 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010689 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010690 server local 127.0.0.1:22
10691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010692srv_id : integer
10693 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
10694 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
10695 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020010696
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010010697
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200106987.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010699----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020010700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010701The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
10702closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
10703when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
10704usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010705future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010706
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010707ssl_bc : boolean
10708 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10709 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
10710 other a server with the "ssl" option.
10711
10712ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
10713 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
10714 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10715
10716ssl_bc_cipher : string
10717 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
10718 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10719
10720ssl_bc_protocol : string
10721 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
10722 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10723
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010724ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010725 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010726 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
10727 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010728
10729ssl_bc_session_id : binary
10730 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
10731 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
10732 if session was reused or not.
10733
10734ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
10735 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
10736 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10737
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010738ssl_c_ca_err : integer
10739 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10740 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
10741 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
10742 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
10743 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010745ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
10746 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10747 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
10748 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
10749 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010750
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010751ssl_c_err : integer
10752 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10753 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
10754 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
10755 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
10756 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010758ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10759 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10760 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10761 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10762 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10763 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10764 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10765 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10766 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010768ssl_c_key_alg : string
10769 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10770 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10771 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010772
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010773ssl_c_notafter : string
10774 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
10775 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10776 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010778ssl_c_notbefore : string
10779 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
10780 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10781 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010783ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10784 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10785 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10786 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10787 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10788 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10789 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10790 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10791 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010793ssl_c_serial : binary
10794 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
10795 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10796 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010798ssl_c_sha1 : binary
10799 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
10800 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
10801 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020010802 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
10803 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
10804
10805 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010807ssl_c_sig_alg : string
10808 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10809 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10810 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010812ssl_c_used : boolean
10813 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
10814 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010815
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010816ssl_c_verify : integer
10817 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
10818 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
10819 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
10820 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010822ssl_c_version : integer
10823 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
10824 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010825
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010826ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10827 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10828 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10829 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10830 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010831 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010832 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10833 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10834 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010835
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010836ssl_f_key_alg : string
10837 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10838 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
10839 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010841ssl_f_notafter : string
10842 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10843 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10844 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010845
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010846ssl_f_notbefore : string
10847 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10848 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10849 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010851ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10852 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10853 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10854 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10855 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10856 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10857 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10858 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10859 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010861ssl_f_serial : binary
10862 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10863 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10864 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010865
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020010866ssl_f_sha1 : binary
10867 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
10868 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
10869 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
10870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010871ssl_f_sig_alg : string
10872 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10873 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10874 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010876ssl_f_version : integer
10877 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10878 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10879
10880ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010881 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10882 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
10883 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
10884
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010885 Example :
10886 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
10887 listen http-https
10888 bind :80
10889 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
10890 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
10891
10892ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
10893 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
10894 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10895
10896ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010897 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010898 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
10899 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
10900 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
10901 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
10902 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
10903 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
10904 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
10905 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
10906
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010907ssl_fc_cipher : string
10908 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
10909 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010910
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010911ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010912 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
10913 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010010914 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
10915 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
10916 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
10917 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010919ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
10920 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020010921 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
10922 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
10923 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10924 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010926ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010927 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010928 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
10929 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
10930 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10931 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
10932 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
10933 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
10934 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020010935
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010936ssl_fc_protocol : string
10937 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
10938 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010939
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010940ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040010941 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010942 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
10943 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040010944
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010945ssl_fc_session_id : binary
10946 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
10947 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
10948 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
10949 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010950
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010951ssl_fc_sni : string
10952 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
10953 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
10954 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
10955 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
10956 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
10957
10958 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
10959 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
10960 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020010961 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
10962 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010963
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010964 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010965 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
10966 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010968ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
10969 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
10970 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010971
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010972
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200109737.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010974------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010975
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010976Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
10977sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
10978only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
10979For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
10980be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
10981can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
10982sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
10983for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
10984content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010985
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010986payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
10987 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
10988 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
10989 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010990
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010991payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
10992 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
10993 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
10994 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010995
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010996req.len : integer
10997req_len : integer (deprecated)
10998 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10999 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11000 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11001 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11002 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11003 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11004 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
11005 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011007req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11008 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011009 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11010 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11011 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11012 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011014 ACL alternatives :
11015 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011017req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11018 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11019 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11020 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
11021 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011023 ACL alternatives :
11024 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011026 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011028req.proto_http : boolean
11029req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
11030 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
11031 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
11032 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
11033 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
11034 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
11035 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
11036 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011038 Example:
11039 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11040 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11041 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011042 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011044req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
11045rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11046 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
11047 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
11048 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
11049 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
11050 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
11051 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
11052 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011054 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
11055 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
11056 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
11057 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
11058 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
11059 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011060
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011061 ACL derivatives :
11062 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011063
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011064 Example :
11065 listen tse-farm
11066 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
11067 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
11068 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11069 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
11070 # apply RDP cookie persistence
11071 persist rdp-cookie
11072 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
11073 # This is only useful makes sense if
11074 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
11075 stick-table type string size 204800
11076 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
11077 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
11078 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011080 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
11081 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011083req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
11084rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
11085 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
11086 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
11087 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
11088 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011090 ACL derivatives :
11091 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011092
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011093req.ssl_hello_type : integer
11094req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11095 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11096 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
11097 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11098 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11099 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
11100 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11101 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011102
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011103req.ssl_sni : string
11104req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
11105 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
11106 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
11107 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
11108 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11109 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11110 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
11111 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
11112 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
11113 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
11114 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
11115 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
11116 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011118 ACL derivatives :
11119 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011121 Examples :
11122 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
11123 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11124 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
11125 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
11126 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011127
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011128res.ssl_hello_type : integer
11129rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11130 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11131 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
11132 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11133 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11134 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
11135 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11136 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020011137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011138req.ssl_ver : integer
11139req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
11140 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
11141 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
11142 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
11143 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
11144 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11145 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11146 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
11147 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
11148 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011149
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011150 ACL derivatives :
11151 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011152
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020011153res.len : integer
11154 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
11155 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11156 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11157 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11158 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11159 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11160 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
11161 content inspection.
11162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011163res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11164 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011165 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11166 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11167 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11168 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011170res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11171 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11172 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11173 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
11174 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011176 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011178wait_end : boolean
11179 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
11180 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
11181 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
11182 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
11183 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
11184 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
11185 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
11186 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011187
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011188 Examples :
11189 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
11190 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
11191 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011193 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
11194 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11195 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
11196 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
11197 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
11198 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
11199 tcp-request content reject
11200
11201
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200112027.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011203--------------------------------------
11204
11205It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
11206This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
11207data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
11208its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
11209HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
11210content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
11211to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
11212more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
11213response are indexed.
11214
11215base : string
11216 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
11217 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
11218 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
11219 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
11220 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
11221 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
11222 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
11223 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
11224
11225 ACL derivatives :
11226 base : exact string match
11227 base_beg : prefix match
11228 base_dir : subdir match
11229 base_dom : domain match
11230 base_end : suffix match
11231 base_len : length match
11232 base_reg : regex match
11233 base_sub : substring match
11234
11235base32 : integer
11236 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
11237 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
11238 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
11239 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer.
11240
11241base32+src : binary
11242 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
11243 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
11244 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
11245 per-URL counters.
11246
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011247capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
11248 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
11249 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11250 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
11251
11252capture.req.method : string
11253 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
11254 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
11255 because it's allocated.
11256
11257capture.req.uri : string
11258 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
11259 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
11260 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
11261 allocated.
11262
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011263capture.req.ver : string
11264 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11265 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
11266 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
11267
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011268capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
11269 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
11270 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11271 The first entry is an index of 0.
11272 See also: "capture response header"
11273
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011274capture.res.ver : string
11275 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11276 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
11277 persistent flag.
11278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011279req.cook([<name>]) : string
11280cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11281 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11282 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11283 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
11284 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
11285 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
11286 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
11287 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
11288 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
11289
11290 ACL derivatives :
11291 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
11292 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
11293 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
11294 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
11295 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
11296 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
11297 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
11298 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011300req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11301cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11302 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11303 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011304
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011305req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11306cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11307 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11308 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
11309 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
11310 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011311
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011312cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11313 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11314 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
11315 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
11316 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
11317 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
11318 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
11319 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
11320 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
11321 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
11322 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011323
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011324hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11325 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
11326 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
11327 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
11328 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011329 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011331req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
11332 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11333 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11334 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11335 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11336 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11337 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
11338 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
11339 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011340
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011341req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11342 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11343 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11344 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11345 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011346
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011347req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11348 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11349 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11350 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11351 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11352 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11353 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
11354 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
11355 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
11356 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
11357 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
11358 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011360 ACL derivatives :
11361 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11362 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11363 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11364 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11365 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11366 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11367 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11368 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11369
11370req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11371hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
11372 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11373 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
11374 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
11375 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
11376 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
11377 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
11378 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
11379 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
11380 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
11381
11382req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11383hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11384 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
11385 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
11386 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
11387 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11388 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11389 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11390 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
11391 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
11392
11393req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11394hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11395 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
11396 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
11397 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
11398 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11399 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11400 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11401 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
11402
11403http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
11404 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
11405 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
11406 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11407 basic auth is supported.
11408
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011409http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
11410 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
11411 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
11412 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
11413 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011414 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11415 basic auth is supported.
11416
11417 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011418 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
11419 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
11420 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
11421 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011422
11423http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011424 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
11425 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011426 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
11427 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011429method : integer + string
11430 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
11431 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
11432 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
11433 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
11434 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
11435 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
11436 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011437
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011438 ACL derivatives :
11439 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011440
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011441 Example :
11442 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
11443 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
11444 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011445
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011446path : string
11447 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
11448 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
11449 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
11450 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
11451 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
11452 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
11453 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011455 ACL derivatives :
11456 path : exact string match
11457 path_beg : prefix match
11458 path_dir : subdir match
11459 path_dom : domain match
11460 path_end : suffix match
11461 path_len : length match
11462 path_reg : regex match
11463 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011465req.ver : string
11466req_ver : string (deprecated)
11467 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
11468 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
11469 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011471 ACL derivatives :
11472 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011473
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011474res.comp : boolean
11475 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
11476 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
11477 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011479res.comp_algo : string
11480 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
11481 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
11482 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011484res.cook([<name>]) : string
11485scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11486 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11487 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11488 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011489
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011490 ACL derivatives :
11491 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011493res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11494scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11495 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11496 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
11497 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011498
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011499res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11500scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11501 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11502 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
11503 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011504
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011505res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11506 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11507 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11508 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11509 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11510 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
11511 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
11512 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
11513 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
11514 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011515
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011516res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11517 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11518 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11519 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11520 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
11521 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011523res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11524shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
11525 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11526 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11527 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11528 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11529 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
11530 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
11531 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
11532 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011533
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011534 ACL derivatives :
11535 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11536 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11537 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11538 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11539 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11540 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11541 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11542 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11543
11544res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11545shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11546 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11547 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11548 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
11549 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
11550 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011552res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11553shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11554 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
11555 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
11556 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
11557 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
11558 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
11559 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011561res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11562shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11563 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
11564 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11565 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11566 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11567 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
11568 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011570res.ver : string
11571resp_ver : string (deprecated)
11572 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
11573 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011575 ACL derivatives :
11576 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011577
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011578set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11579 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11580 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
11581 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
11582 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011583
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011584 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
11585 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011587 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011589status : integer
11590 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
11591 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
11592 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011593
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011594url : string
11595 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
11596 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
11597 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
11598 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
11599 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
11600 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
11601 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011603 ACL derivatives :
11604 url : exact string match
11605 url_beg : prefix match
11606 url_dir : subdir match
11607 url_dom : domain match
11608 url_end : suffix match
11609 url_len : length match
11610 url_reg : regex match
11611 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011613url_ip : ip
11614 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
11615 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
11616 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
11617 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
11618 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
11619 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11620 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011622url_port : integer
11623 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
11624 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
11625 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11626 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011628urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11629url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11630 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
11631 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
11632 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
11633 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
11634 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
11635 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
11636 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
11637 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
11638 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011640 ACL derivatives :
11641 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
11642 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
11643 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
11644 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
11645 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
11646 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
11647 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
11648 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011649
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011651 Example :
11652 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
11653 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
11654 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
11655 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011657urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
11658 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
11659 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
11660 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020011661
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010011662
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200116637.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011664---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011665
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011666Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
11667every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011668order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011669
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011670ACL name Equivalent to Usage
11671---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011672FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020011673HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011674HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
11675HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011676HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
11677HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
11678HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
11679HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
11680LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011681METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
11682METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
11683METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
11684METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
11685METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
11686METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020011687RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011688REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011689TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011690WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
11691---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011692
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011693
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116948. Logging
11695----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011696
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011697One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
11698provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
11699very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
11700provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
11701state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011702to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011703headers.
11704
11705In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
11706about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
11707send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
11708
11709 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
11710 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
11711 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
11712 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
11713 at the termination.
11714
11715The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
11716allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
11717as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
11718while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
11719real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
11720delay.
11721
11722
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117238.1. Log levels
11724---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011725
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011726TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011727source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011728HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
11729in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
11730track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
11731syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
11732about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011733
11734
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117358.2. Log formats
11736----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011737
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011738HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011739and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
11740slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
11741options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011742
11743 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
11744 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
11745 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
11746 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
11747 extents.
11748
11749 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
11750 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
11751 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
11752 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
11753 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
11754
11755 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
11756 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
11757 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
11758 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
11759 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
11760
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020011761 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
11762 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
11763 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
11764 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
11765
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011766 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
11767
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011768Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
11769specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
11770field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
11771servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
11772always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
11773identifier.
11774
11775Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
11776 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
11777 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
11778 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
11779 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
11780
11781
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117828.2.1. Default log format
11783-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011784
11785This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
11786as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
11787format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
11788
11789 Example :
11790 listen www
11791 mode http
11792 log global
11793 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11794
11795 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
11796 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
11797 (www/HTTP)
11798
11799 Field Format Extract from the example above
11800 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
11801 2 'Connect from' Connect from
11802 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
11803 4 'to' to
11804 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
11805 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
11806
11807Detailed fields description :
11808 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
11809 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
11810 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
11811 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
11812 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11813 and processed the connection.
11814 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
11815
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011816In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
11817"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
11818connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
11819
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011820It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
11821will eventually disappear.
11822
11823
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118248.2.2. TCP log format
11825---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011826
11827The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
11828is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
11829information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
11830counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
11831emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
11832environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
11833the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
11834sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011835specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
11836not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
11837fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
11838marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011839
11840 Example :
11841 frontend fnt
11842 mode tcp
11843 option tcplog
11844 log global
11845 default_backend bck
11846
11847 backend bck
11848 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11849
11850 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
11851 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
11852 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
11853
11854 Field Format Extract from the example above
11855 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
11856 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
11857 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
11858 4 frontend_name fnt
11859 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
11860 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
11861 7 bytes_read* 212
11862 8 termination_state --
11863 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
11864 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11865
11866Detailed fields description :
11867 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011868 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11869 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11870 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11871 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11872 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011873
11874 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011875 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11876 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11877 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011878
11879 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
11880 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
11881 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
11882 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
11883
11884 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11885 and processed the connection.
11886
11887 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11888 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11889 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
11890 applications.
11891
11892 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11893 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11894 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11895 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
11896 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
11897
11898 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11899 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11900 See "Timers" below for more details.
11901
11902 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11903 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11904 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
11905 "Timers" below for more details.
11906
11907 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011908 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011909 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11910 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11911 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11912 details.
11913
11914 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
11915 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
11916 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
11917 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
11918 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
11919
11920 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11921 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11922 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
11923 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
11924 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
11925 for more details.
11926
11927 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011928 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011929 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
11930 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
11931 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011932 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011933
11934 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11935 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11936 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11937 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11938 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11939 caused by a denial of service attack.
11940
11941 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11942 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11943 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11944 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11945 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11946 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11947 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11948 denial of service attack.
11949
11950 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11951 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11952 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11953 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11954 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11955 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11956 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11957 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
11958 be processed than on other servers.
11959
11960 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11961 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11962 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11963 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11964 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11965 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11966 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11967 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11968 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11969 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11970 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11971 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11972 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11973
11974 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11975 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11976 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11977 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11978 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11979 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11980 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11981 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11982
11983 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11984 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11985 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11986 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11987 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11988 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11989 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11990 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11991 occurs.
11992
11993
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200119948.2.3. HTTP log format
11995----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011996
11997The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
11998is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
11999the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
12000are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
12001emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
12002generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
12003"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
12004which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012005frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
12006is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012007
12008Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
12009slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
12010with a star ('*') after the field name below.
12011
12012 Example :
12013 frontend http-in
12014 mode http
12015 option httplog
12016 log global
12017 default_backend bck
12018
12019 backend static
12020 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12021
12022 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
12023 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
12024 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012025 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012026
12027 Field Format Extract from the example above
12028 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
12029 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
12030 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
12031 4 frontend_name http-in
12032 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
12033 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
12034 7 status_code 200
12035 8 bytes_read* 2750
12036 9 captured_request_cookie -
12037 10 captured_response_cookie -
12038 11 termination_state ----
12039 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
12040 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
12041 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
12042 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
12043 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012044
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012045
12046Detailed fields description :
12047 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012048 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
12049 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
12050 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
12051 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
12052 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012053
12054 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012055 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
12056 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
12057 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012058
12059 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
12060 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
12061 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
12062 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
12063 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
12064
12065 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12066 and processed the connection.
12067
12068 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
12069 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
12070 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
12071
12072 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
12073 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
12074 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
12075 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
12076 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
12077 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
12078
12079 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
12080 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
12081 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
12082 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
12083 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
12084 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
12085
12086 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
12087 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
12088 See "Timers" below for more details.
12089
12090 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
12091 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
12092 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
12093 below for more details.
12094
12095 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
12096 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
12097 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
12098 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
12099 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
12100 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
12101 for more details.
12102
12103 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012104 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012105 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
12106 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
12107 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
12108 details.
12109
12110 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
12111 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
12112 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
12113
12114 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
12115 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
12116 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
12117 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
12118 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
12119 overflowing.
12120
12121 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
12122 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
12123 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
12124 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
12125 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
12126 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
12127 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
12128 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12129
12130 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
12131 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
12132 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
12133 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
12134 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
12135 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
12136 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
12137 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12138
12139 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
12140 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
12141 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
12142 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
12143 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
12144 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
12145 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
12146
12147 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012148 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012149 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
12150 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
12151 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012152 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012153 system.
12154
12155 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
12156 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
12157 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
12158 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
12159 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
12160 caused by a denial of service attack.
12161
12162 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
12163 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
12164 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
12165 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
12166 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
12167 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
12168 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
12169 denial of service attack.
12170
12171 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
12172 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
12173 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
12174 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
12175 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
12176 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
12177 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
12178 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
12179 processed than on other servers.
12180
12181 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
12182 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
12183 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
12184 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
12185 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
12186 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
12187 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
12188 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
12189 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
12190 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
12191 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
12192 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
12193 should not be attributed to the logged server.
12194
12195 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12196 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
12197 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
12198 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
12199 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
12200 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
12201 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
12202 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
12203
12204 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12205 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
12206 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
12207 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
12208 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
12209 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
12210 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
12211 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
12212 occurs.
12213
12214 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
12215 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
12216 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
12217 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
12218 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
12219 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
12220 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
12221 cookies" below for more details.
12222
12223 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
12224 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
12225 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
12226 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
12227 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
12228 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
12229 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
12230 and cookies" below for more details.
12231
12232 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
12233 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
12234 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
12235 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
12236 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
12237 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
12238 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
12239 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
12240
12241
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200122428.2.4. Custom log format
12243------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012244
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012245The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012246mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012247
12248HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
12249Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
12250separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
12251prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
12252
12253Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
12254variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
12255string formats ("Q").
12256
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012257If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012258as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012259less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
12260the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
12261
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012262Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012263In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010012264in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012265
12266Flags are :
12267 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012268 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012269
12270 Example:
12271
12272 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
12273 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
12274
12275At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
12276
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012277 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
12278 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012279
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012280the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012281
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012282 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012283 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012284 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012285
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012286and the default TCP format is defined this way :
12287
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012288 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012289 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
12290
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012291Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
12292
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012293 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012294 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012295 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
12296 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
12297 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012298 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
12299 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
12300 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012301 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012302 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020012303 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012304 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012305 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080012306 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012307 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
12308 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012309 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012310 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
12311 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012312 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012313 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
12314 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012315 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12316 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
12317 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012318 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012319 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
12320 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012321 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012322 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12323 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
12324 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012325 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020012326 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
12327 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
12328 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
12329 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012330 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012331 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012332 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012333 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010012334 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012335 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012336 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
12337 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
12338 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012339 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012340 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
12341 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012342 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012343 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012344 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012345 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012346
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012347 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012348
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010012349
123508.2.5. Error log format
12351-----------------------
12352
12353When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
12354protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
12355By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
12356"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
12357will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
12358logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
12359
12360The format looks like this :
12361
12362 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
12363 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
12364 Connection error during SSL handshake
12365
12366 Field Format Extract from the example above
12367 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
12368 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
12369 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
12370 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
12371 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
12372
12373These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
12374failures.
12375
12376
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123778.3. Advanced logging options
12378-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012379
12380Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
12381just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
12382options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
12383for more information about their usage.
12384
12385
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123868.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
12387------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012388
12389It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
12390haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
12391commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
12392monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
12393ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
12394
12395 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
12396 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
12397 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
12398 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
12399
12400 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
12401 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
12402 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012403 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012404 such as other load-balancers.
12405
12406 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
12407 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
12408 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
12409
12410
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124118.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
12412----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012413
12414The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
12415what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
12416or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
12417"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
12418just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
12419log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
12420after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
12421is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
12422with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
12423with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
12424
12425
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124268.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
12427------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012428
12429Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
12430for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
12431"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
12432retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
12433raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
12434a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
12435file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
12436you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
12437"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
12438
12439
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124408.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
12441--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012442
12443Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
12444multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
12445them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
12446"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
12447logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
12448error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
12449and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
12450too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
12451useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
12452alternative.
12453
12454
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124558.4. Timing events
12456------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012457
12458Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
12459reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
12460the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
12461frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
12462mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
12463
12464 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
12465 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
12466 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
12467 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
12468 the client closes prematurely or times out.
12469
12470 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
12471 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
12472 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
12473 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
12474 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
12475
12476 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
12477 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
12478 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
12479 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
12480 connection never established.
12481
12482 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
12483 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
12484 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
12485 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
12486 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
12487 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
12488 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
12489 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
12490 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
12491 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
12492 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
12493
12494 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
12495 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
12496 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
12497 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012498 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012499
12500 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
12501
12502 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
12503 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
12504 negative.
12505
12506These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
12507protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
12508that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012509due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012510close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
12511session has been aborted on timeout.
12512
12513Most common cases :
12514
12515 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12516 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
12517 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
12518 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
12519 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
12520 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
12521 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
12522 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
12523 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020012524 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
12525 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
12526 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012527
12528 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12529 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
12530 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
12531 of ms on remote networks.
12532
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012533 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
12534 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
12535 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012536
12537 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
12538 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
12539 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
12540 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
12541 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
12542 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
12543 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
12544 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
12545 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
12546 to the server until another one is released.
12547
12548Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
12549
12550 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
12551 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
12552 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
12553
12554 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
12555 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
12556 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
12557
12558 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
12559 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
12560 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
12561 flags.
12562
12563 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
12564 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
12565 Check the session termination flags, then check the
12566 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
12567 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
12568 the client connection was maintained open.
12569
12570 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012571 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012572 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
12573 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
12574
12575
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125768.5. Session state at disconnection
12577-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012578
12579TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
12580"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
125812-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
12582each of which has a special meaning :
12583
12584 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
12585 session to terminate :
12586
12587 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
12588
12589 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
12590 server explicitly refused it.
12591
12592 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
12593 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
12594 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
12595 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012596 (eg: cacheable cookie).
12597
12598 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
12599 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012600
12601 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
12602 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
12603 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
12604 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
12605 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
12606
12607 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
12608 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
12609 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
12610 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
12611 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
12612
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090012613 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
12614 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
12615
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012616 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
12617 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
12618 backup connections when going up.
12619
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020012620 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
12621
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012622 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
12623 send or receive data.
12624
12625 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
12626 send or receive data.
12627
12628 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
12629 with nothing left in the buffers.
12630
12631 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
12632
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010012633 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012634 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
12635
12636 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
12637 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
12638 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
12639 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
12640 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
12641
12642 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
12643 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
12644
12645 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
12646 server (HTTP only).
12647
12648 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
12649
12650 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
12651 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
12652 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
12653
12654 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
12655 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
12656 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
12657
12658 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
12659
12660 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
12661 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
12662
12663 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
12664 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
12665 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
12666
12667 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
12668 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020012669 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
12670 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012671
12672 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
12673 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
12674 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
12675 another server.
12676
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012677 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012678 server.
12679
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012680 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
12681 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
12682 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
12683 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12684
12685 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
12686 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
12687 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
12688 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12689
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020012690 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
12691 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
12692 "use-server" rule).
12693
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012694 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12695
12696 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
12697 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
12698
12699 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
12700
12701 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
12702 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
12703 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
12704
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012705 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
12706 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012707 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012708 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
12709 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
12710
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012711 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
12712
12713 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
12714 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
12715
12716 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
12717
12718 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12719
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012720The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
12721was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012722helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
12723starvation, attacks, etc...
12724
12725The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
12726alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
12727easier finding and understanding.
12728
12729 Flags Reason
12730
12731 -- Normal termination.
12732
12733 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
12734 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
12735 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
12736 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
12737
12738 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
12739 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
12740 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
12741 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
12742 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
12743 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012744
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012745 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12746 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012747 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012748
12749 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
12750 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
12751 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
12752
12753 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
12754 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
12755 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
12756 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
12757 the server takes too long to respond.
12758
12759 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
12760 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
12761 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
12762 long a time to respond.
12763
12764 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
12765 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
12766 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
12767 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
12768 and the client.
12769
12770 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
12771 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
12772 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
12773 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
12774 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012775 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
12776 some browsers such as Google Chrome started to break the deployed Web
12777 infrastructure by aggressively implementing a new "pre-connect"
12778 feature, consisting in sending connections to sites recently visited
12779 without sending any request on them until the user starts to browse
12780 the site. This mechanism causes massive disruption among resource-
12781 limited servers, and causes a lot of 408 errors in HAProxy logs.
12782 Worse, some people report that sometimes the browser displays the 408
12783 error when the user expects to see the actual content (Mozilla fixed
12784 this bug in 2004, while Chrome users continue to report it in 2014),
12785 so in this case, using "errorfile 408 /dev/null" can be used as a
12786 workaround. More information on the subject is available here :
12787 https://bugzilla.mozilla.org/show_bug.cgi?id=248827
12788 https://code.google.com/p/chromium/issues/detail?id=85229
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012789
12790 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
12791 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012792 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
12793 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
12794 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
12795 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012796
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012797 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
12798 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
12799
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012800 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012801 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
12802 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
12803 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
12804 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
12805 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
12806
12807 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
12808 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
12809 503 or 504 here.
12810
12811 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
12812 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
12813 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
12814 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
12815 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
12816
12817 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12818 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012819 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012820 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
12821 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
12822
12823 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
12824 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
12825 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
12826 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
12827 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
12828 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
12829 between haproxy and the server.
12830
12831 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
12832 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
12833 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
12834 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
12835 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
12836 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
12837 solution is to fix the application.
12838
12839 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
12840 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
12841 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
12842 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
12843 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
12844 external attacks.
12845
12846 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
12847 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012848 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012849 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
12850 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
12851
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012852 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
12853 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
12854 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020012855 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
12856 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012857
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012858 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
12859 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
12860 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
12861 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012862 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
12863 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
12864 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
12865 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
12866 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012867
12868 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
12869 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
12870 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
12871 returned an HTTP 403 error.
12872
12873 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
12874 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
12875 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
12876 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
12877
12878 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
12879 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
12880 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
12881 only be solved by proper system tuning.
12882
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012883The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
12884persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
12885important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
12886re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
12887
12888 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
12889
12890 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12891 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
12892 set on a GET request.
12893
12894 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
12895 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012896 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012897 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
12898
12899 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
12900 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
12901 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
12902
12903 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12904 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
12905 already got a cookie.
12906
12907 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12908 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
12909 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
12910 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
12911 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
12912
12913 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12914 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12915 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12916
12917 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
12918 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12919 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12920
12921 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
12922 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
12923
12924 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
12925 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
12926 then advertised in the response.
12927
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012928
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129298.6. Non-printable characters
12930-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012931
12932In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
12933consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
12934converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
12935prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
12936being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
12937escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
12938is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
12939'}' when logging headers.
12940
12941Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
12942issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
12943containing spaces is "User-Agent".
12944
12945Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
12946the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
12947performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
12948
12949
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129508.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
12951---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012952
12953Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
12954achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012955section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012956cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
12957the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
12958the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012959locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012960not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
12961user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
12962a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
12963wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
12964
12965 Examples :
12966 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
12967 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
12968
12969 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
12970 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
12971
12972
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129738.8. Capturing HTTP headers
12974---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012975
12976Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
12977proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
12978the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
12979server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
12980
12981Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
12982response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012983section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012984
12985It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012986time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
12987appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012988are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
12989and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
12990follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
12991request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
12992in the logs.
12993
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020012994As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
12995frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
12996an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
12997
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012998 Example :
12999 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
13000 listen proxy-out
13001 mode http
13002 option httplog
13003 option logasap
13004 log global
13005 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
13006
13007 # log the name of the virtual server
13008 capture request header Host len 20
13009
13010 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
13011 capture request header Content-Length len 10
13012
13013 # log the beginning of the referrer
13014 capture request header Referer len 20
13015
13016 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
13017 capture response header Server len 20
13018
13019 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
13020 capture response header Content-Length len 10
13021
13022 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
13023 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
13024
13025 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
13026 capture response header Via len 20
13027
13028 # log the URL location during a redirection
13029 capture response header Location len 20
13030
13031 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
13032 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
13033 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13034 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
13035 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
13036
13037 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13038 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13039 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13040 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013041 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013042
13043 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13044 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13045 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13046 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
13047 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013048 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013049
13050
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200130518.9. Examples of logs
13052---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013053
13054These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
13055them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
13056reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
13057
13058 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
13059 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13060 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13061
13062 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
13063 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
13064
13065 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
13066 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
13067 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13068
13069 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
13070 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
13071
13072 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
13073 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13074 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
13075
13076 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013077 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013078 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
13079 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
13080
13081 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
13082 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
13083 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
13084
13085 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
13086 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020013087 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013088 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
13089 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
13090 to return the 502 and not the server.
13091
13092 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013093 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013094
13095 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
13096 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
13097 Nothing was sent to any server.
13098
13099 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
13100 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
13101
13102 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
13103 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
13104 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
13105 send a 408 return code to the client.
13106
13107 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
13108 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
13109
13110 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
13111 5 seconds ("c----").
13112
13113 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
13114 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013115 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013116
13117 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013118 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013119 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
13120 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
13121 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
13122 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
13123 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013124
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013125
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131269. Statistics and monitoring
13127----------------------------
13128
13129It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
13130mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
13131CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
13132Unix socket.
13133
13134
131359.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013136---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010013137
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013138The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
Willy Tarreaua3310dc2014-06-16 15:43:21 +020013139page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow. The first line
13140begins with a sharp ('#') and has one word per comma-delimited field which
13141represents the title of the column. All other lines starting at the second one
13142use a classical CSV format using a comma as the delimiter, and the double quote
13143('"') as an optional text delimiter, but only if the enclosed text is ambiguous
13144(if it contains a quote or a comma). The double-quote character ('"') in the
13145text is doubled ('""'), which is the format that most tools recognize. Please
13146do not insert any column before these ones in order not to break tools which
13147use hard-coded column positions.
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013148
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010013149 0. pxname: proxy name
13150 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
13151 for server)
13152 2. qcur: current queued requests
13153 3. qmax: max queued requests
13154 4. scur: current sessions
13155 5. smax: max sessions
13156 6. slim: sessions limit
13157 7. stot: total sessions
13158 8. bin: bytes in
13159 9. bout: bytes out
13160 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013161 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010013162 12. ereq: request errors
13163 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010013164 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010013165 15. wretr: retries (warning)
13166 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010013167 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010013168 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
13169 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
13170 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
13171 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
13172 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
13173 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
13174 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
13175 25. qlimit: queue limit
13176 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
13177 27. iid: unique proxy id
13178 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
13179 29. throttle: warm up status
13180 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
13181 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020013182 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020013183 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
13184 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
13185 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020013186 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013187 UNK -> unknown
13188 INI -> initializing
13189 SOCKERR -> socket error
13190 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
13191 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
13192 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
13193 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
13194 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
13195 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
13196 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
13197 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
13198 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
13199 disable-on-404
13200 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
13201 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
13202 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020013203 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
13204 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013205 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
13206 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
13207 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
13208 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
13209 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
13210 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013211 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
13212 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
13213 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
13214 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010013215 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
13216 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau55058a72012-11-21 08:27:21 +010013217 51. comp_in: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
13218 52. comp_out: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
13219 53. comp_byp: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor (CPU/BW limit)
Willy Tarreau11d4ec82012-11-26 00:49:03 +010013220 54. comp_rsp: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
Willy Tarreauf522f3d2014-02-10 22:22:49 +010013221 55. lastsess: number of seconds since last session assigned to server/backend
Willy Tarreaua28df3e2014-06-16 16:40:14 +020013222 56. last_chk: last health check contents or textual error
13223 57. last_agt: last agent check contents or textual error
Willy Tarreauf5b1cc32014-06-17 12:20:59 +020013224 58. qtime: the average queue time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13225 59. ctime: the average connect time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13226 60. rtime: the average response time in ms over the 1024 last requests (0 for TCP)
13227 61. ttime: the average total session time in ms over the 1024 last requests
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013228
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013229
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200132309.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013231-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013232
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013233The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
13234necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
13235A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
13236issuing commands by hand :
13237
13238 global
13239 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
13240 stats timeout 2m
13241
13242It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
13243the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
13244never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
13245situations :
13246
13247 global
13248 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
13249 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
13250 stats timeout 2m
13251
13252To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
13253swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
13254to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
13255syntaxes we'll use are the following :
13256
13257 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
13258 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
13259
13260The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
13261script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
13262for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
13263
13264The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
13265that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
13266editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
13267(eg: watch a counter).
13268
13269The socket supports two operation modes :
13270 - interactive
13271 - non-interactive
13272
13273The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
13274this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
13275sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
13276mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
13277commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
13278example :
13279
13280 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
13281
13282The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
13283entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
13284for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
13285sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
13286"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
13287after processing the last command of the same line.
13288
13289For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
13290"prompt" command :
13291
13292 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
13293 prompt
13294 > show info
13295 ...
13296 >
13297
13298Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
13299delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
13300that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
13301parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013302
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013303It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
13304on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
13305own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013306
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013307The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
13308If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
13309all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
13310it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
13311
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013312add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013313 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
13314 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
13315 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
13316 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013317
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013318add map <map> <key> <value>
13319 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
13320 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013321 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
13322 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
13323 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013324
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013325clear counters
13326 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
13327 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
13328 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
13329 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
13330 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13331
13332clear counters all
13333 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
13334 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
13335 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
13336
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013337clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013338 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
13339 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
13340 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013341
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013342clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013343 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
13344 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
13345 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013346
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013347clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
13348 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
13349
13350 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
13351 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
13352 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
13353 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
13354 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
13355 later after the session ends is usual enough.
13356
13357 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
13358
13359 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
13360 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
13361 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
13362 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
13363 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
13364 the ACLs :
13365
13366 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13367 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13368 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13369 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13370 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13371 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13372
13373 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013374 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
13375 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013376
13377 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013378 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013379 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013380 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13381 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13382 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13383 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013384
13385 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13386
13387 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013388 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013389 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13390 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013391 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13392 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13393 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013394
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013395del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
13396 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013397 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
13398 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13399 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
13400 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013401
13402del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013403 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013404 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
13405 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13406 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
13407 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013408
13409disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013410 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
13411
13412 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
13413 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
13414 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
13415 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
13416 re-enabled using enable agent.
13417
13418 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
13419 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
13420 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
13421 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
13422 otherwise unchanged.
13423
13424 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
13425 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
13426 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
13427
13428 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13429 level "admin".
13430
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013431disable frontend <frontend>
13432 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
13433 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
13434 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
13435 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
13436 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
13437 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
13438 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
13439 on the stats page.
13440
13441 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13442 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13443
13444 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13445 level "admin".
13446
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013447disable health <backend>/<server>
13448 Mark the primary health check as temporarily stopped. This will disable
13449 sending of health checks, and the last health check result will be ignored.
13450 The server will be in unchecked state and considered UP unless an auxiliary
13451 agent check forces it down.
13452
13453 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13454 level "admin".
13455
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013456disable server <backend>/<server>
13457 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
13458 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
13459 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
13460 during the maintenance.
13461
13462 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
13463 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
13464
13465 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013466 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013467
13468 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13469 level "admin".
13470
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013471enable agent <backend>/<server>
13472 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
13473
13474 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
13475 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
13476
13477 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13478 level "admin".
13479
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013480enable frontend <frontend>
13481 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
13482 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
13483 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
13484 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
13485 which was disabled.
13486
13487 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13488 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13489
13490 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13491 level "admin".
13492
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013493enable health <backend>/<server>
13494 Resume a primary health check that was temporarily stopped. This will enable
13495 sending of health checks again. Please see "disable health" for details.
13496
13497 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13498 level "admin".
13499
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013500enable server <backend>/<server>
13501 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
13502 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
13503
13504 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013505 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013506
13507 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13508 level "admin".
13509
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013510get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013511get acl <acl> <value>
13512 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
13513 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
13514 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
13515 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
13516 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013517
13518 The first two words are:
13519
13520 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
13521 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
13522 "dom", "end" or "reg".
13523
13524 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
13525
13526 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
13527
13528 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
13529
13530 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
13531 interpretation of the case.
13532
13533 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
13534 useful with regular expressions.
13535
13536 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
13537 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
13538
13539 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
13540 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
13541 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
13542
13543 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
13544
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013545get weight <backend>/<server>
13546 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
13547 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
13548 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
13549 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
13550 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013551 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013552
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013553help
13554 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
13555 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013556
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013557prompt
13558 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
13559 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
13560 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
13561 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
13562 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
13563 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
13564 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
13565 command.
13566
13567quit
13568 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013569
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013570set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013571 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
13572 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
13573 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013574
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013575set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020013576 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
13577 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
13578 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
13579 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
13580 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013581 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
13582 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13583
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020013584set maxconn global <maxconn>
13585 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
13586 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
13587 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
13588 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
13589 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
13590 setting.
13591
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020013592set rate-limit connections global <value>
13593 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
13594 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13595 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13596 is passed in number of connections per second.
13597
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013598set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
13599 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
13600 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010013601 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
13602 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013603
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020013604set rate-limit sessions global <value>
13605 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
13606 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13607 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13608 is passed in number of sessions per second.
13609
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020013610set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
13611 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
13612 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13613 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13614 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
13615 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
13616
Willy Tarreau2a4b70f2014-05-22 18:42:35 +020013617set server <backend>/<server> agent [ up | down ]
13618 Force a server's agent to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
13619 switch a server's state regardless of some slow agent checks for example.
13620 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
13621
13622set server <backend>/<server> health [ up | stopping | down ]
13623 Force a server's health to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
13624 switch a server's state regardless of some slow health checks for example.
13625 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
13626
13627set server <backend>/<server> state [ ready | drain | maint ]
13628 Force a server's administrative state to a new state. This can be useful to
13629 disable load balancing and/or any traffic to a server. Setting the state to
13630 "ready" puts the server in normal mode, and the command is the equivalent of
13631 the "enable server" command. Setting the state to "maint" disables any traffic
13632 to the server as well as any health checks. This is the equivalent of the
13633 "disable server" command. Setting the mode to "drain" only removes the server
13634 from load balancing but still allows it to be checked and to accept new
13635 persistent connections. Changes are propagated to tracking servers if any.
13636
13637set server <backend>/<server> weight <weight>[%]
13638 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. This is the exact
13639 equivalent of the "set weight" command below.
13640
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013641set ssl ocsp-response <response>
13642 This command is used to update an OCSP Response for a certificate (see "crt"
13643 on "bind" lines). Same controls are performed as during the initial loading of
13644 the response. The <response> must be passed as a base64 encoded string of the
13645 DER encoded response from the OCSP server.
13646
13647 Example:
13648 openssl ocsp -issuer issuer.pem -cert server.pem \
13649 -host ocsp.issuer.com:80 -respout resp.der
13650 echo "set ssl ocsp-response $(base64 -w 10000 resp.der)" | \
13651 socat stdio /var/run/haproxy.stat
13652
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013653set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013654 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
13655 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
13656 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
13657 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013658 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
13659 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013660
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013661set timeout cli <delay>
13662 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
13663 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
13664 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
13665
13666set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
13667 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
13668 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090013669 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
13670 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
13671 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
13672 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
13673 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
13674 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
13675 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
13676 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
13677 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
13678 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
13679 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
13680 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
13681 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013682
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013683show errors [<iid>]
13684 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
13685 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013686 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
13687 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
13688 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013689
13690 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
13691 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
13692 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
13693 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
13694 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
13695 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
13696 are reported too.
13697
13698 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
13699 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
13700 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
13701 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
13702 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
13703 code.
13704
13705 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
13706 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
13707 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
13708 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
13709 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
13710 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
13711 line.
13712
13713 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013714 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13715 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013716 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
13717 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
13718
13719 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
13720 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
13721 00038 Location: blah\r\n
13722 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
13723 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
13724 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
13725 00204+ minal\r\n
13726 00211 \r\n
13727
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013728 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013729 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
13730 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
13731 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
13732 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
13733 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
13734 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013735
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013736show info
13737 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
13738
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013739show map [<map>]
13740 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013741 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
13742 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
13743 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
13744 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
13745 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
13746 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013747
13748show acl [<acl>]
13749 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013750 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
13751 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
13752 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
13753 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
13754 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013755
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010013756show pools
13757 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
13758 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
13759 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
13760 the pools.
13761
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013762show sess
13763 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013764 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
13765 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13766
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010013767show sess <id>
13768 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
13769 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13770 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
13771 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
13772 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Willy Tarreau76153662012-11-26 01:16:39 +010013773 freely evolve depending on demands. The special id "all" dumps the states of
13774 all sessions, which can be avoided as much as possible as it is highly CPU
13775 intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013776
13777show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
13778 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
13779 possible to dump only selected items :
13780 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
13781 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
13782 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
13783 for example:
13784 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
13785 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
13786 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
13787
13788 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013789 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
13790 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013791 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
13792 Release_date: 2009/09/23
13793 Nbproc: 1
13794 Process_num: 1
13795 (...)
13796
13797 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
13798 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
13799 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
13800 (...)
13801 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
13802
13803 $
13804
13805 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
13806 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
13807 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
13808 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013809 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013810
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013811show table
13812 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
13813 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
13814 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
13815 entries currently in use.
13816
13817 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013818 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013819 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
13820 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013821
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013822show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013823 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
13824 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
13825 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013826 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
13827
13828 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
13829 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
13830 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
13831 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
13832 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
13833
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013834 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13835 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13836 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13837 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13838 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13839 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13840
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013841
13842 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013843 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
13844 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013845
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013846 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013847 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013848 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013849 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13850 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13851 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13852 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013853
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013854 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013855 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013856 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13857 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013858
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013859 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
13860 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013861 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013862 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13863 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013864
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013865 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
13866 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013867 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013868 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13869 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
13870
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013871 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
13872 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
13873 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
13874 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
13875 time goes, the average event rate drops.
13876
13877 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
13878 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
13879 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013880 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
13881 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013882 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
13883 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020013884
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013885shutdown frontend <frontend>
13886 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
13887 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
13888 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
13889 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
13890 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
13891 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
13892 once it is terminated.
13893
13894 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13895 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13896
13897 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13898 level "admin".
13899
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020013900shutdown session <id>
13901 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
13902 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13903 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
13904 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
13905 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
13906 flag in the logs.
13907
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020013908shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
13909 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
13910 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
13911 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
13912 'K' flag in the logs.
13913
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013914/*
13915 * Local variables:
13916 * fill-column: 79
13917 * End:
13918 */